Merge from trunk.
[bpt/emacs.git] / src / xterm.c
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993-2011 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
6
7 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
19
20 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
21 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
22
23 #include <config.h>
24 #include <signal.h>
25 #include <stdio.h>
26 #include <setjmp.h>
27
28 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
29
30 #include "lisp.h"
31 #include "blockinput.h"
32
33 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
34 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
35 #include "syssignal.h"
36
37 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
38 if this is not done before the other system files. */
39 #include "xterm.h"
40 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
41
42 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
43 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
44 #ifndef makedev
45 #include <sys/types.h>
46 #endif /* makedev */
47
48 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
49
50 #include "systime.h"
51
52 #include <fcntl.h>
53 #include <ctype.h>
54 #include <errno.h>
55 #include <setjmp.h>
56 #include <sys/stat.h>
57 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
58 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
59
60 #include "charset.h"
61 #include "character.h"
62 #include "coding.h"
63 #include "frame.h"
64 #include "dispextern.h"
65 #include "fontset.h"
66 #include "termhooks.h"
67 #include "termopts.h"
68 #include "termchar.h"
69 #include "emacs-icon.h"
70 #include "disptab.h"
71 #include "buffer.h"
72 #include "window.h"
73 #include "keyboard.h"
74 #include "intervals.h"
75 #include "process.h"
76 #include "atimer.h"
77 #include "keymap.h"
78 #include "font.h"
79 #include "fontset.h"
80 #include "xsettings.h"
81 #include "xgselect.h"
82 #include "sysselect.h"
83
84 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
85 #include <X11/Shell.h>
86 #endif
87
88 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
89 #include <sys/time.h>
90 #endif
91
92 #include <unistd.h>
93
94 #ifdef USE_GTK
95 #include "gtkutil.h"
96 #endif
97
98 #ifdef USE_LUCID
99 #include "../lwlib/xlwmenu.h"
100 #endif
101
102 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
103 #if !defined (NO_EDITRES)
104 #define HACK_EDITRES
105 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages (Widget, XtPointer, XEvent *, Boolean *);
106 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
107
108 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
109
110 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
111 #if defined USE_MOTIF
112 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
113 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
114 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
115
116 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
117 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
118 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
119 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
120 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
121 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
122 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
123 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
124 #ifndef XtNpickTop
125 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
126 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
127 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
128 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
129
130 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
131
132 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
133 #include "widget.h"
134 #ifndef XtNinitialState
135 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
136 #endif
137 #endif
138
139 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
140 #ifdef USE_XIM
141 int use_xim = 1;
142 #else
143 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
144 #endif
145
146 \f
147
148 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
149 start. */
150
151 static int any_help_event_p;
152
153 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
154 static Lisp_Object last_window;
155
156 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
157 use. */
158
159 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
160
161 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
162 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
163 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
164 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
165
166 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
167
168 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
169 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
170 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
171 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
172
173 extern struct frame *updating_frame;
174
175 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
176
177 static struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
178
179 /* This is a frame waiting for an event matching mask, within XTread_socket. */
180
181 static struct {
182 struct frame *f;
183 int eventtype;
184 } pending_event_wait;
185
186 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
187 /* The application context for Xt use. */
188 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
189 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
190
191 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
192
193 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
194 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
195
196 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
197 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
198 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
199
200 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
201
202 /* Mouse movement.
203
204 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
205 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
206 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
207 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
208
209 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
210
211 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
212 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
213 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
214 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
215 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
216 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
217 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
218 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
219 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
220 is off. */
221
222 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
223
224 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
225 static FRAME_PTR last_mouse_glyph_frame;
226 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
227
228 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
229
230 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
231 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
232 an ordinary motion.
233
234 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
235 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
236 event. */
237
238 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
239
240 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
241 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
242 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
243 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
244 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
245 it's somewhat accurate. */
246
247 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
248
249 /* Time for last user interaction as returned in X events. */
250
251 static Time last_user_time;
252
253 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
254 events. */
255
256 #ifdef __STDC__
257 static int volatile input_signal_count;
258 #else
259 static int input_signal_count;
260 #endif
261
262 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
263
264 static int x_noop_count;
265
266 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
267
268 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
269 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
270
271 #ifdef USE_GTK
272 /* The name of the Emacs icon file. */
273 static Lisp_Object xg_default_icon_file;
274
275 /* Used in gtkutil.c. */
276 Lisp_Object Qx_gtk_map_stock;
277 #endif
278
279 /* Some functions take this as char *, not const char *. */
280 static char emacs_class[] = EMACS_CLASS;
281
282 enum xembed_info
283 {
284 XEMBED_MAPPED = 1 << 0
285 };
286
287 enum xembed_message
288 {
289 XEMBED_EMBEDDED_NOTIFY = 0,
290 XEMBED_WINDOW_ACTIVATE = 1,
291 XEMBED_WINDOW_DEACTIVATE = 2,
292 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS = 3,
293 XEMBED_FOCUS_IN = 4,
294 XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT = 5,
295 XEMBED_FOCUS_NEXT = 6,
296 XEMBED_FOCUS_PREV = 7,
297
298 XEMBED_MODALITY_ON = 10,
299 XEMBED_MODALITY_OFF = 11,
300 XEMBED_REGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 12,
301 XEMBED_UNREGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 13,
302 XEMBED_ACTIVATE_ACCELERATOR = 14
303 };
304
305 /* Used in x_flush. */
306
307 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *, Colormap, XColor *);
308 static void x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *, int, int, int);
309 static void x_raise_frame (struct frame *);
310 static void x_lower_frame (struct frame *);
311 static const XColor *x_color_cells (Display *, int *);
312 static void x_update_window_end (struct window *, int, int);
313
314 static int x_io_error_quitter (Display *);
315 static struct terminal *x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *);
316 void x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *);
317 static void x_update_end (struct frame *);
318 static void XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *);
319 static void XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
320 static void XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
321 static void x_clear_frame (struct frame *);
322 static void x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *, int, int) NO_RETURN;
323 static void frame_highlight (struct frame *);
324 static void frame_unhighlight (struct frame *);
325 static void x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *, struct frame *);
326 static void x_focus_changed (int, int, struct x_display_info *,
327 struct frame *, struct input_event *);
328 static void x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *,
329 XEvent *, struct input_event *);
330 static void XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *);
331 static void x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *);
332 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *);
333 static void x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
334 enum text_cursor_kinds);
335
336 static void x_clip_to_row (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int, GC);
337 static void x_flush (struct frame *f);
338 static void x_update_begin (struct frame *);
339 static void x_update_window_begin (struct window *);
340 static void x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *);
341 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *, Window);
342 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
343 enum scroll_bar_part *,
344 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
345 Time *);
346 static void x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *, XPropertyEvent *);
347 static void x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *);
348 static void x_check_expected_move (struct frame *, int, int);
349 static void x_sync_with_move (struct frame *, int, int, int);
350 static int handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
351 int *, struct input_event *);
352 #ifdef USE_GTK
353 static int x_dispatch_event (XEvent *, Display *);
354 #endif
355 /* Don't declare this NO_RETURN because we want no
356 interference with debugging failing X calls. */
357 static void x_connection_closed (Display *, const char *);
358 static void x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *, int);
359 static void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *, ptrdiff_t);
360 static void x_initialize (void);
361
362
363 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
364
365 static void
366 x_flush (struct frame *f)
367 {
368 /* Don't call XFlush when it is not safe to redisplay; the X
369 connection may be broken. */
370 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
371 return;
372
373 BLOCK_INPUT;
374 if (f == NULL)
375 {
376 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
377 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
378 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
379 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
380 }
381 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
382 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
383 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
384 }
385
386
387 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
388 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
389 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
390 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
391 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
392 performance. */
393
394 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
395
396 \f
397 /***********************************************************************
398 Debugging
399 ***********************************************************************/
400
401 #if 0
402
403 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
404 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
405
406 struct record
407 {
408 char *locus;
409 int type;
410 };
411
412 struct record event_record[100];
413
414 int event_record_index;
415
416 void
417 record_event (char *locus, int type)
418 {
419 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
420 event_record_index = 0;
421
422 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
423 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
424 event_record_index++;
425 }
426
427 #endif /* 0 */
428
429
430 \f
431 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
432
433 struct x_display_info *
434 x_display_info_for_display (Display *dpy)
435 {
436 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
437
438 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
439 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
440 return dpyinfo;
441
442 return 0;
443 }
444
445 static Window
446 x_find_topmost_parent (struct frame *f)
447 {
448 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x;
449 Window win = None, wi = x->parent_desc;
450 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
451
452 while (wi != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
453 {
454 Window root;
455 Window *children;
456 unsigned int nchildren;
457
458 win = wi;
459 XQueryTree (dpy, win, &root, &wi, &children, &nchildren);
460 XFree (children);
461 }
462
463 return win;
464 }
465
466 #define OPAQUE 0xffffffff
467
468 void
469 x_set_frame_alpha (struct frame *f)
470 {
471 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
472 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
473 Window win = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
474 double alpha = 1.0;
475 double alpha_min = 1.0;
476 unsigned long opac;
477 Window parent;
478
479 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame == f)
480 alpha = f->alpha[0];
481 else
482 alpha = f->alpha[1];
483
484 if (FLOATP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
485 alpha_min = XFLOAT_DATA (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit);
486 else if (INTEGERP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
487 alpha_min = (XINT (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit)) / 100.0;
488
489 if (alpha < 0.0)
490 return;
491 else if (alpha > 1.0)
492 alpha = 1.0;
493 else if (0.0 <= alpha && alpha < alpha_min && alpha_min <= 1.0)
494 alpha = alpha_min;
495
496 opac = alpha * OPAQUE;
497
498 x_catch_errors (dpy);
499
500 /* If there is a parent from the window manager, put the property there
501 also, to work around broken window managers that fail to do that.
502 Do this unconditionally as this function is called on reparent when
503 alpha has not changed on the frame. */
504
505 parent = x_find_topmost_parent (f);
506 if (parent != None)
507 XChangeProperty (dpy, parent, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
508 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
509 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
510
511 /* return unless necessary */
512 {
513 unsigned char *data;
514 Atom actual;
515 int rc, format;
516 unsigned long n, left;
517
518 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
519 0L, 1L, False, XA_CARDINAL,
520 &actual, &format, &n, &left,
521 &data);
522
523 if (rc == Success && actual != None)
524 {
525 unsigned long value = *(unsigned long *)data;
526 XFree ((void *) data);
527 if (value == opac)
528 {
529 x_uncatch_errors ();
530 return;
531 }
532 }
533 }
534
535 XChangeProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
536 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
537 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
538 x_uncatch_errors ();
539 }
540
541 int
542 x_display_pixel_height (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
543 {
544 return HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
545 }
546
547 int
548 x_display_pixel_width (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
549 {
550 return WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
551 }
552
553 \f
554 /***********************************************************************
555 Starting and ending an update
556 ***********************************************************************/
557
558 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
559 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
560 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
561 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
562 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
563
564 static void
565 x_update_begin (struct frame *f)
566 {
567 /* Nothing to do. */
568 }
569
570
571 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
572 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
573 position of W. */
574
575 static void
576 x_update_window_begin (struct window *w)
577 {
578 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
579 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
580
581 updated_window = w;
582 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
583
584 BLOCK_INPUT;
585
586 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
587 {
588 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
589 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 1;
590
591 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
592 highlighting. */
593 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
594 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
595 }
596
597 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
598 }
599
600
601 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
602
603 static void
604 x_draw_vertical_window_border (struct window *w, int x, int y0, int y1)
605 {
606 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
607 struct face *face;
608
609 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
610 if (face)
611 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
612 face->foreground);
613
614 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
615 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
616 }
617
618 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
619
620 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
621 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
622
623 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
624 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
625 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
626
627 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
628 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
629 here. */
630
631 static void
632 x_update_window_end (struct window *w, int cursor_on_p, int mouse_face_overwritten_p)
633 {
634 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
635
636 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
637 {
638 BLOCK_INPUT;
639
640 if (cursor_on_p)
641 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
642 output_cursor.vpos,
643 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
644
645 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
646 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
647
648 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
649 }
650
651 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
652 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
653 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
654 {
655 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
656 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
657 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
658 }
659
660 updated_window = NULL;
661 }
662
663
664 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
665 update_end. */
666
667 static void
668 x_update_end (struct frame *f)
669 {
670 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
671 MOUSE_HL_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
672
673 #ifndef XFlush
674 BLOCK_INPUT;
675 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
676 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
677 #endif
678 }
679
680
681 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
682 complete update has been performed. The global variable
683 updated_window is not available here. */
684
685 static void
686 XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *f)
687 {
688 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
689 {
690 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
691
692 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
693 || f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
694 {
695 BLOCK_INPUT;
696 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
697 note_mouse_highlight (hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
698 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
699 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
700 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
701 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
702 }
703 }
704 }
705
706
707 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
708 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
709 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
710 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
711 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
712 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
713
714 static void
715 x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *desired_row)
716 {
717 struct window *w = updated_window;
718 struct frame *f;
719 int width, height;
720
721 xassert (w);
722
723 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
724 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
725
726 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
727 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
728 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
729 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
730 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
731 overhead is very small. */
732 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
733 && desired_row->full_width_p
734 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
735 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
736 width != 0)
737 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
738 height > 0))
739 {
740 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
741
742 BLOCK_INPUT;
743 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
744 0, y, width, height, False);
745 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
746 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
747 y, width, height, False);
748 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
749 }
750 }
751
752 static void
753 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p)
754 {
755 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
756 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
757 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
758 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
759 struct face *face = p->face;
760
761 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
762 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
763
764 if (!p->overlay_p)
765 {
766 int bx = p->bx, by = p->by, nx = p->nx, ny = p->ny;
767
768 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
769 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
770 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
771 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
772 if (face->stipple)
773 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
774 else
775 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
776
777 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
778 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
779 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
780 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
781 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
782 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
783 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
784 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
785 {
786 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
787
788 if (sb_width > 0)
789 {
790 int bar_area_x = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
791 int bar_area_width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
792 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
793
794 if (bx < 0)
795 {
796 /* Bitmap fills the fringe. */
797 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == p->x)
798 bx = bar_area_x + sb_width;
799 else if (p->x + p->wd == bar_area_x)
800 bx = bar_area_x;
801 if (bx >= 0)
802 {
803 int header_line_height = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
804
805 nx = bar_area_width - sb_width;
806 by = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
807 row->y));
808 ny = row->visible_height;
809 }
810 }
811 else
812 {
813 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == bx)
814 {
815 bx = bar_area_x + sb_width;
816 nx += bar_area_width - sb_width;
817 }
818 else if (bx + nx == bar_area_x)
819 nx += bar_area_width - sb_width;
820 }
821 }
822 }
823 #endif
824 if (bx >= 0 && nx > 0)
825 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc, bx, by, nx, ny);
826
827 if (!face->stipple)
828 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
829 }
830
831 if (p->which)
832 {
833 char *bits;
834 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
835 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
836 XGCValues gcv;
837
838 if (p->wd > 8)
839 bits = (char *) (p->bits + p->dh);
840 else
841 bits = (char *) p->bits + p->dh;
842
843 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
844 by the server. */
845 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
846 (p->cursor_p
847 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
848 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
849 : face->foreground),
850 face->background, depth);
851
852 if (p->overlay_p)
853 {
854 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
855 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
856 bits, p->wd, p->h,
857 1, 0, 1);
858 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
859 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
860 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
861 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
862 }
863
864 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
865 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
866 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
867
868 if (p->overlay_p)
869 {
870 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
871 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
872 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
873 }
874 }
875
876 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
877 }
878
879 \f
880
881 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
882 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
883 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
884 rarely happens). */
885
886 static void
887 XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
888 {
889 }
890
891 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
892 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
893
894 static void
895 XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
896 {
897 }
898
899 \f
900 /***********************************************************************
901 Glyph display
902 ***********************************************************************/
903
904
905
906 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *);
907 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *);
908 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *,
909 int);
910 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
911 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
912 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *);
913 static void x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
914 static void x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *, int) NO_RETURN;
915 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *);
916 static void x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *);
917 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
918 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
919 static int x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
920 unsigned long *, double, int);
921 static void x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *, struct relief *,
922 double, int, unsigned long);
923 static void x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *);
924 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
925 static void x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *);
926 static void x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
927 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *, Pixmap);
928 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *, int,
929 int, int, int);
930 static void x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
931 int, int, int, int, int, int,
932 XRectangle *);
933 static void x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
934 int, int, int, XRectangle *);
935 static void x_scroll_bar_clear (struct frame *);
936
937 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
938 static void x_check_font (struct frame *, struct font *);
939 #endif
940
941
942 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
943 face. */
944
945 static void
946 x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
947 {
948 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
949 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
950 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
951 && !s->cmp)
952 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
953 else
954 {
955 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
956 XGCValues xgcv;
957 unsigned long mask;
958
959 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
960 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
961
962 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
963 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
964 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
965 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
966 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
967 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
968 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
969
970 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
971 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
972 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
973 {
974 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
975 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
976 }
977
978 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
979 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
980 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
981
982 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
983 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
984 mask, &xgcv);
985 else
986 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
987 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
988
989 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
990 }
991 }
992
993
994 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
995
996 static void
997 x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
998 {
999 int face_id;
1000 struct face *face;
1001
1002 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
1003 face_id = MOUSE_HL_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
1004 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1005 if (face == NULL)
1006 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
1007
1008 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1009 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch, -1, Qnil);
1010 else
1011 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
1012 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1013 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1014
1015 if (s->font == s->face->font)
1016 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1017 else
1018 {
1019 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
1020 except for FONT. */
1021 XGCValues xgcv;
1022 unsigned long mask;
1023
1024 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
1025 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1026 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1027 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
1028
1029 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1030 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1031 mask, &xgcv);
1032 else
1033 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1034 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1035
1036 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1037
1038 }
1039 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1040 }
1041
1042
1043 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1044 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1045 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1046
1047 static inline void
1048 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1049 {
1050 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1051 }
1052
1053
1054 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1055 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1056 pattern. */
1057
1058 static inline void
1059 x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1060 {
1061 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1062
1063 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1064 {
1065 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1066 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1067 }
1068 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1069 {
1070 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1071 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1072 }
1073 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1074 {
1075 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1076 s->stippled_p = 0;
1077 }
1078 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1079 {
1080 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1081 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1082 }
1083 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1084 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1085 {
1086 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1087 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1088 }
1089 else
1090 {
1091 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1092 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1093 }
1094
1095 /* GC must have been set. */
1096 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1097 }
1098
1099
1100 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1101 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1102
1103 static inline void
1104 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *s)
1105 {
1106 XRectangle *r = s->clip;
1107 int n = get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s, r, 2);
1108
1109 if (n > 0)
1110 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, r, n, Unsorted);
1111 s->num_clips = n;
1112 }
1113
1114
1115 /* Set SRC's clipping for output of glyph string DST. This is called
1116 when we are drawing DST's left_overhang or right_overhang only in
1117 the area of SRC. */
1118
1119 static void
1120 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (struct glyph_string *src, struct glyph_string *dst)
1121 {
1122 XRectangle r;
1123
1124 r.x = src->x;
1125 r.width = src->width;
1126 r.y = src->y;
1127 r.height = src->height;
1128 dst->clip[0] = r;
1129 dst->num_clips = 1;
1130 XSetClipRectangles (dst->display, dst->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1131 }
1132
1133
1134 /* RIF:
1135 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. */
1136
1137 static void
1138 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *s)
1139 {
1140 if (s->cmp == NULL
1141 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
1142 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
1143 {
1144 struct font_metrics metrics;
1145
1146 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1147 {
1148 unsigned *code = alloca (sizeof (unsigned) * s->nchars);
1149 struct font *font = s->font;
1150 int i;
1151
1152 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++)
1153 code[i] = (s->char2b[i].byte1 << 8) | s->char2b[i].byte2;
1154 font->driver->text_extents (font, code, s->nchars, &metrics);
1155 }
1156 else
1157 {
1158 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1159
1160 composition_gstring_width (gstring, s->cmp_from, s->cmp_to, &metrics);
1161 }
1162 s->right_overhang = (metrics.rbearing > metrics.width
1163 ? metrics.rbearing - metrics.width : 0);
1164 s->left_overhang = metrics.lbearing < 0 ? - metrics.lbearing : 0;
1165 }
1166 else if (s->cmp)
1167 {
1168 s->right_overhang = s->cmp->rbearing - s->cmp->pixel_width;
1169 s->left_overhang = - s->cmp->lbearing;
1170 }
1171 }
1172
1173
1174 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1175
1176 static inline void
1177 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
1178 {
1179 XGCValues xgcv;
1180 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1181 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1182 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1183 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1184 }
1185
1186
1187 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1188 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1189 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1190 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1191 contains the first component of a composition. */
1192
1193 static void
1194 x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *s, int force_p)
1195 {
1196 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1197 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1198 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1199 {
1200 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1201
1202 if (s->stippled_p)
1203 {
1204 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1205 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1206 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1207 s->y + box_line_width,
1208 s->background_width,
1209 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1210 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1211 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1212 }
1213 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1214 || s->font_not_found_p
1215 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1216 || force_p)
1217 {
1218 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1219 s->background_width,
1220 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1221 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1222 }
1223 }
1224 }
1225
1226
1227 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1228
1229 static void
1230 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1231 {
1232 int i, x;
1233
1234 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1235 of S to the right of that box line. */
1236 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1237 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1238 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1239 else
1240 x = s->x;
1241
1242 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1243 loaded. */
1244 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1245 {
1246 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1247 {
1248 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1249 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1250 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1251 s->height - 1);
1252 x += g->pixel_width;
1253 }
1254 }
1255 else
1256 {
1257 struct font *font = s->font;
1258 int boff = font->baseline_offset;
1259 int y;
1260
1261 if (font->vertical_centering)
1262 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, s->f) - boff;
1263
1264 y = s->ybase - boff;
1265 if (s->for_overlaps
1266 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1267 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 0);
1268 else
1269 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 1);
1270 if (s->face->overstrike)
1271 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x + 1, y, 0);
1272 }
1273 }
1274
1275 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1276
1277 static void
1278 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1279 {
1280 int i, j, x;
1281 struct font *font = s->font;
1282
1283 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1284 of S to the right of that box line. */
1285 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1286 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1287 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1288 else
1289 x = s->x;
1290
1291 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->cmp_from is the index
1292 of the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1293 S->cmp_from == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1294 this composition. */
1295
1296 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1297 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1298 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1299 {
1300 if (s->cmp_from == 0)
1301 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1302 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1303 }
1304 else if (! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
1305 {
1306 int y = s->ybase;
1307
1308 for (i = 0, j = s->cmp_from; i < s->nchars; i++, j++)
1309 /* TAB in a composition means display glyphs with padding
1310 space on the left or right. */
1311 if (COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s->cmp, j) != '\t')
1312 {
1313 int xx = x + s->cmp->offsets[j * 2];
1314 int yy = y - s->cmp->offsets[j * 2 + 1];
1315
1316 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx, yy, 0);
1317 if (s->face->overstrike)
1318 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx + 1, yy, 0);
1319 }
1320 }
1321 else
1322 {
1323 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1324 Lisp_Object glyph;
1325 int y = s->ybase;
1326 int width = 0;
1327
1328 for (i = j = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp_to; i++)
1329 {
1330 glyph = LGSTRING_GLYPH (gstring, i);
1331 if (NILP (LGLYPH_ADJUSTMENT (glyph)))
1332 width += LGLYPH_WIDTH (glyph);
1333 else
1334 {
1335 int xoff, yoff, wadjust;
1336
1337 if (j < i)
1338 {
1339 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1340 if (s->face->overstrike)
1341 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1342 x += width;
1343 }
1344 xoff = LGLYPH_XOFF (glyph);
1345 yoff = LGLYPH_YOFF (glyph);
1346 wadjust = LGLYPH_WADJUST (glyph);
1347 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff, y + yoff, 0);
1348 if (s->face->overstrike)
1349 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff + 1, y + yoff, 0);
1350 x += wadjust;
1351 j = i + 1;
1352 width = 0;
1353 }
1354 }
1355 if (j < i)
1356 {
1357 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1358 if (s->face->overstrike)
1359 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1360 }
1361 }
1362 }
1363
1364
1365 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S for glyphless characters. */
1366
1367 static void
1368 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1369 {
1370 struct glyph *glyph = s->first_glyph;
1371 XChar2b char2b[8];
1372 int x, i, j;
1373
1374 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1375 of S to the right of that box line. */
1376 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1377 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1378 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1379 else
1380 x = s->x;
1381
1382 s->char2b = char2b;
1383
1384 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, glyph++)
1385 {
1386 char buf[7], *str = NULL;
1387 int len = glyph->u.glyphless.len;
1388
1389 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM)
1390 {
1391 if (len > 0
1392 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display)
1393 && (CHAR_TABLE_EXTRA_SLOTS (XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display))
1394 >= 1))
1395 {
1396 Lisp_Object acronym
1397 = (! glyph->u.glyphless.for_no_font
1398 ? CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display,
1399 glyph->u.glyphless.ch)
1400 : XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display)->extras[0]);
1401 if (STRINGP (acronym))
1402 str = SSDATA (acronym);
1403 }
1404 }
1405 else if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE)
1406 {
1407 sprintf ((char *) buf, "%0*X",
1408 glyph->u.glyphless.ch < 0x10000 ? 4 : 6,
1409 glyph->u.glyphless.ch);
1410 str = buf;
1411 }
1412
1413 if (str)
1414 {
1415 int upper_len = (len + 1) / 2;
1416 unsigned code;
1417
1418 /* It is assured that all LEN characters in STR is ASCII. */
1419 for (j = 0; j < len; j++)
1420 {
1421 code = s->font->driver->encode_char (s->font, str[j]);
1422 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b + j, code >> 8, code & 0xFF);
1423 }
1424 s->font->driver->draw (s, 0, upper_len,
1425 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_xoff,
1426 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_yoff,
1427 0);
1428 s->font->driver->draw (s, upper_len, len,
1429 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_xoff,
1430 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_yoff,
1431 0);
1432 }
1433 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method != GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE)
1434 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1435 x, s->ybase - glyph->ascent,
1436 glyph->pixel_width - 1,
1437 glyph->ascent + glyph->descent - 1);
1438 x += glyph->pixel_width;
1439 }
1440 }
1441
1442 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1443
1444 static struct frame *x_frame_of_widget (Widget);
1445 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1446 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *);
1447 static void cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1448 XrmValue *, Cardinal *);
1449
1450
1451 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1452 cannot be determined. */
1453
1454 static struct frame *
1455 x_frame_of_widget (Widget widget)
1456 {
1457 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1458 Lisp_Object tail;
1459 struct frame *f;
1460
1461 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1462
1463 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1464 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1465 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1466 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1467 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1468 widget = XtParent (widget);
1469
1470 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1471 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1472 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
1473 if (FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
1474 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
1475 (FRAME_X_P (f)
1476 && f->output_data.nothing != 1
1477 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
1478 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1479 return f;
1480
1481 abort ();
1482 }
1483
1484
1485 #ifdef USE_LUCID
1486
1487 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1488 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1489 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1490 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1491 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1492 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1493
1494 int
1495 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (Widget widget, Display *display, Colormap cmap,
1496 unsigned long *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1497 {
1498 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1499 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1500 }
1501
1502 #endif
1503
1504
1505 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1506 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1507
1508 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1509 {
1510 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1511 sizeof (Screen *)},
1512 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1513 sizeof (Colormap)}
1514 };
1515
1516
1517 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1518 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1519
1520 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1521
1522
1523 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1524
1525 DPY is the display we are working on.
1526
1527 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1528 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1529 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1530 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1531
1532 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1533 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1534
1535 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1536 we allocated the color or not.
1537
1538 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1539
1540 static Boolean
1541 cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *dpy, XrmValue *args, Cardinal *nargs,
1542 XrmValue *from, XrmValue *to,
1543 XtPointer *closure_ret)
1544 {
1545 Screen *screen;
1546 Colormap cmap;
1547 Pixel pixel;
1548 String color_name;
1549 XColor color;
1550
1551 if (*nargs != 2)
1552 {
1553 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1554 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1555 "XtToolkitError",
1556 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1557 return False;
1558 }
1559
1560 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1561 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1562 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1563
1564 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1565 {
1566 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1567 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1568 }
1569 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1570 {
1571 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1572 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1573 }
1574 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1575 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1576 {
1577 pixel = color.pixel;
1578 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1579 }
1580 else
1581 {
1582 String params[1];
1583 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1584
1585 params[0] = color_name;
1586 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1587 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1588 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1589 params, &nparams);
1590 return False;
1591 }
1592
1593 if (to->addr != NULL)
1594 {
1595 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1596 {
1597 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1598 return False;
1599 }
1600
1601 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1602 }
1603 else
1604 {
1605 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1606 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1607 }
1608
1609 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1610 return True;
1611 }
1612
1613
1614 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1615 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1616 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1617
1618 APP is the application context in which we work.
1619
1620 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1621 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1622 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1623
1624 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1625
1626 static void
1627 cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext app, XrmValuePtr to, XtPointer closure, XrmValuePtr args,
1628 Cardinal *nargs)
1629 {
1630 if (*nargs != 2)
1631 {
1632 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1633 "XtToolkitError",
1634 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1635 NULL, NULL);
1636 }
1637 else if (closure != NULL)
1638 {
1639 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1640 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1641 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1642 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1643 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1644 }
1645 }
1646
1647
1648 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1649
1650
1651 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1652 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1653 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1654 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1655
1656 static const XColor *
1657 x_color_cells (Display *dpy, int *ncells)
1658 {
1659 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1660
1661 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1662 {
1663 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1664 int ncolor_cells = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1665 int i;
1666
1667 dpyinfo->color_cells = xnmalloc (ncolor_cells,
1668 sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1669 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = ncolor_cells;
1670
1671 for (i = 0; i < ncolor_cells; ++i)
1672 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1673
1674 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1675 dpyinfo->color_cells, ncolor_cells);
1676 }
1677
1678 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1679 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1680 }
1681
1682
1683 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1684 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1685
1686 void
1687 x_query_colors (struct frame *f, XColor *colors, int ncolors)
1688 {
1689 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1690
1691 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1692 {
1693 int i;
1694 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1695 {
1696 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1697 xassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1698 xassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1699 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1700 }
1701 }
1702 else
1703 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1704 }
1705
1706
1707 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1708 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1709
1710 void
1711 x_query_color (struct frame *f, XColor *color)
1712 {
1713 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1714 }
1715
1716
1717 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1718 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1719 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1720 allocated. */
1721
1722 static int
1723 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *dpy, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1724 {
1725 int rc;
1726
1727 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1728 if (rc == 0)
1729 {
1730 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1731 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1732 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1733 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1734 int nearest, i;
1735 int max_color_delta = 255;
1736 int max_delta = 3 * max_color_delta;
1737 int nearest_delta = max_delta + 1;
1738 int ncells;
1739 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1740
1741 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1742 {
1743 int dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1744 int dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1745 int dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1746 int delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1747
1748 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1749 {
1750 nearest = i;
1751 nearest_delta = delta;
1752 }
1753 }
1754
1755 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1756 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1757 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1758 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1759 }
1760 else
1761 {
1762 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1763 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1764 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1765 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1766 XColor *cached_color;
1767
1768 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1769 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1770 (cached_color->red != color->red
1771 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1772 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1773 {
1774 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1775 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1776 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1777 }
1778 }
1779
1780 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1781 if (rc)
1782 register_color (color->pixel);
1783 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1784
1785 return rc;
1786 }
1787
1788
1789 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1790 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1791 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1792 allocated. */
1793
1794 int
1795 x_alloc_nearest_color (struct frame *f, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1796 {
1797 gamma_correct (f, color);
1798 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1799 }
1800
1801
1802 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1803 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1804 get color reference counts right. */
1805
1806 unsigned long
1807 x_copy_color (struct frame *f, long unsigned int pixel)
1808 {
1809 XColor color;
1810
1811 color.pixel = pixel;
1812 BLOCK_INPUT;
1813 x_query_color (f, &color);
1814 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1815 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1816 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1817 register_color (pixel);
1818 #endif
1819 return color.pixel;
1820 }
1821
1822
1823 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1824 boosted.
1825
1826 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1827 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1828 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1829 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1830 use an additional additive factor.
1831
1832 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1833 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1834 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1835
1836
1837 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1838 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1839 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1840 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1841 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1842 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1843
1844 static int
1845 x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *f, Display *display, Colormap cmap, long unsigned int *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1846 {
1847 XColor color, new;
1848 long bright;
1849 int success_p;
1850
1851 /* Get RGB color values. */
1852 color.pixel = *pixel;
1853 x_query_color (f, &color);
1854
1855 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1856 xassert (factor >= 0);
1857 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1858 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1859 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1860
1861 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1862 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1863
1864 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1865 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1866 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1867 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1868 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1869 {
1870 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1871 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1872 /* The additive adjustment. */
1873 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1874
1875 if (factor < 1)
1876 {
1877 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1878 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1879 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1880 }
1881 else
1882 {
1883 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1884 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1885 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1886 }
1887 }
1888
1889 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1890 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1891 if (success_p)
1892 {
1893 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1894 {
1895 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1896 delta to the RGB values. */
1897 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1898
1899 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1900 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1901 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1902 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1903 }
1904 else
1905 success_p = 1;
1906 *pixel = new.pixel;
1907 }
1908
1909 return success_p;
1910 }
1911
1912
1913 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1914 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1915 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1916 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1917 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1918 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1919
1920 static void
1921 x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *f, struct relief *relief, double factor, int delta, long unsigned int default_pixel)
1922 {
1923 XGCValues xgcv;
1924 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1925 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1926 unsigned long pixel;
1927 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1928 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1929 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1930 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1931
1932 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1933 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1934
1935 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1936 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1937 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1938 if (relief->gc
1939 && relief->allocated_p)
1940 {
1941 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1942 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1943 }
1944
1945 /* Allocate new color. */
1946 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1947 pixel = background;
1948 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1949 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1950 {
1951 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1952 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1953 }
1954
1955 if (relief->gc == 0)
1956 {
1957 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1958 mask |= GCStipple;
1959 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1960 }
1961 else
1962 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1963 }
1964
1965
1966 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1967
1968 static void
1969 x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *s)
1970 {
1971 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1972 unsigned long color;
1973
1974 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1975 color = s->face->box_color;
1976 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1977 && s->img->pixmap
1978 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1979 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1980 else
1981 {
1982 XGCValues xgcv;
1983
1984 /* Get the background color of the face. */
1985 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
1986 color = xgcv.background;
1987 }
1988
1989 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
1990 || color != di->relief_background)
1991 {
1992 di->relief_background = color;
1993 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
1994 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1995 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
1996 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1997 }
1998 }
1999
2000
2001 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
2002 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
2003 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
2004 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
2005 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
2006 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
2007 when drawing. */
2008
2009 static void
2010 x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *f,
2011 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
2012 int raised_p, int top_p, int bot_p, int left_p, int right_p,
2013 XRectangle *clip_rect)
2014 {
2015 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
2016 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
2017 int i;
2018 GC gc;
2019
2020 if (raised_p)
2021 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2022 else
2023 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2024 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2025
2026 /* This code is more complicated than it has to be, because of two
2027 minor hacks to make the boxes look nicer: (i) if width > 1, draw
2028 the outermost line using the black relief. (ii) Omit the four
2029 corner pixels. */
2030
2031 /* Top. */
2032 if (top_p)
2033 {
2034 if (width == 1)
2035 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2036 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2037 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2038
2039 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2040 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2041 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2042 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2043 }
2044
2045 /* Left. */
2046 if (left_p)
2047 {
2048 if (width == 1)
2049 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2050
2051 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2052 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2053
2054 for (i = (width > 1 ? 1 : 0); i < width; ++i)
2055 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2056 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
2057 }
2058
2059 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2060 if (raised_p)
2061 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2062 else
2063 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2064 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2065
2066 if (width > 1)
2067 {
2068 /* Outermost top line. */
2069 if (top_p)
2070 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2071 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2072 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2073
2074 /* Outermost left line. */
2075 if (left_p)
2076 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2077 }
2078
2079 /* Bottom. */
2080 if (bot_p)
2081 {
2082 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2083 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), bottom_y,
2084 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), bottom_y);
2085 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2086 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2087 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2088 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2089 }
2090
2091 /* Right. */
2092 if (right_p)
2093 {
2094 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2095 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2096 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2097 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2098 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
2099 }
2100
2101 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2102 }
2103
2104
2105 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2106 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2107 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2108 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2109 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2110 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2111
2112 static void
2113 x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *s,
2114 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
2115 int left_p, int right_p, XRectangle *clip_rect)
2116 {
2117 XGCValues xgcv;
2118
2119 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2120 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2121 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2122
2123 /* Top. */
2124 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2125 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2126
2127 /* Left. */
2128 if (left_p)
2129 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2130 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2131
2132 /* Bottom. */
2133 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2134 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2135
2136 /* Right. */
2137 if (right_p)
2138 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2139 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2140
2141 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2142 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2143 }
2144
2145
2146 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2147
2148 static void
2149 x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *s)
2150 {
2151 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2152 int left_p, right_p;
2153 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2154 XRectangle clip_rect;
2155
2156 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2157 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2158 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2159
2160 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2161 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2162 ? s->first_glyph
2163 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2164
2165 width = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2166 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2167 left_x = s->x;
2168 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2169 ? last_x - 1
2170 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2171 top_y = s->y;
2172 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2173
2174 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2175 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2176 && (s->prev == NULL
2177 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2178 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2179 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2180 && (s->next == NULL
2181 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2182
2183 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2184
2185 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2186 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2187 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2188 else
2189 {
2190 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2191 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2192 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2193 }
2194 }
2195
2196
2197 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2198
2199 static void
2200 x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
2201 {
2202 int x = s->x;
2203 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2204
2205 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2206 right of that line. */
2207 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2208 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2209 && s->slice.x == 0)
2210 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2211
2212 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2213 by that margin. */
2214 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2215 x += s->img->hmargin;
2216 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2217 y += s->img->vmargin;
2218
2219 if (s->img->pixmap)
2220 {
2221 if (s->img->mask)
2222 {
2223 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2224 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2225 trust on the shape extension to be available
2226 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2227 manually. */
2228 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2229 | GCFunction);
2230 XGCValues xgcv;
2231 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2232
2233 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2234 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2235 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2236 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2237 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2238
2239 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2240 image_rect.x = x;
2241 image_rect.y = y;
2242 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2243 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2244 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2245 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2246 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2247 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2248 }
2249 else
2250 {
2251 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2252
2253 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2254 image_rect.x = x;
2255 image_rect.y = y;
2256 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2257 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2258 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2259 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2260 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2261 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2262
2263 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2264 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2265 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2266 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2267 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2268 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2269 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2270 {
2271 int relief = s->img->relief;
2272 if (relief < 0) relief = -relief;
2273 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2274 x - relief, y - relief,
2275 s->slice.width + relief*2 - 1,
2276 s->slice.height + relief*2 - 1);
2277 }
2278 }
2279 }
2280 else
2281 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2282 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2283 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2284 }
2285
2286
2287 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2288
2289 static void
2290 x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *s)
2291 {
2292 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p, extra;
2293 XRectangle r;
2294 int x = s->x;
2295 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2296
2297 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2298 right of that line. */
2299 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2300 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2301 && s->slice.x == 0)
2302 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2303
2304 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2305 by that margin. */
2306 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2307 x += s->img->hmargin;
2308 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2309 y += s->img->vmargin;
2310
2311 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2312 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2313 {
2314 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2315 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2316 }
2317 else
2318 {
2319 thick = eabs (s->img->relief);
2320 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2321 }
2322
2323 extra = s->face->id == TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID
2324 ? XINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin) : 0;
2325
2326 x0 = x - thick - extra;
2327 y0 = y - thick - extra;
2328 x1 = x + s->slice.width + thick - 1 + extra;
2329 y1 = y + s->slice.height + thick - 1 + extra;
2330
2331 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2332 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2333 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2334 s->slice.y == 0,
2335 s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height,
2336 s->slice.x == 0,
2337 s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width,
2338 &r);
2339 }
2340
2341
2342 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2343
2344 static void
2345 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *s, Pixmap pixmap)
2346 {
2347 int x = 0;
2348 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2349
2350 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2351 right of that line. */
2352 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2353 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2354 && s->slice.x == 0)
2355 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2356
2357 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2358 by that margin. */
2359 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2360 x += s->img->hmargin;
2361 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2362 y += s->img->vmargin;
2363
2364 if (s->img->pixmap)
2365 {
2366 if (s->img->mask)
2367 {
2368 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2369 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2370 trust on the shape extension to be available
2371 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2372 manually. */
2373 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2374 | GCFunction);
2375 XGCValues xgcv;
2376
2377 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2378 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2379 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2380 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2381 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2382
2383 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2384 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2385 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2386 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2387 }
2388 else
2389 {
2390 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2391 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2392 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2393
2394 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2395 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2396 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2397 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2398 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2399 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2400 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2401 {
2402 int r = s->img->relief;
2403 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2404 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2405 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2406 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2407 }
2408 }
2409 }
2410 else
2411 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2412 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2413 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2414 }
2415
2416
2417 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2418 give the rectangle to draw. */
2419
2420 static void
2421 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
2422 {
2423 if (s->stippled_p)
2424 {
2425 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2426 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2427 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2428 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2429 }
2430 else
2431 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2432 }
2433
2434
2435 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2436
2437 s->y
2438 s->x +-------------------------
2439 | s->face->box
2440 |
2441 | +-------------------------
2442 | | s->img->margin
2443 | |
2444 | | +-------------------
2445 | | | the image
2446
2447 */
2448
2449 static void
2450 x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2451 {
2452 int box_line_hwidth = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2453 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2454 int height;
2455 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2456
2457 height = s->height;
2458 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2459 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2460 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2461 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2462
2463 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2464 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2465 flickering. */
2466 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2467 if (height > s->slice.height
2468 || s->img->hmargin
2469 || s->img->vmargin
2470 || s->img->mask
2471 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2472 || s->width != s->background_width)
2473 {
2474 if (s->img->mask)
2475 {
2476 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2477 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2478 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2479 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2480 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2481
2482 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2483 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2484 s->background_width,
2485 s->height, depth);
2486
2487 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2488 pixmap. */
2489 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2490
2491 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2492 if (s->stippled_p)
2493 {
2494 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2495 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2496 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, - s->x, - s->y);
2497 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2498 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2499 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2500 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0);
2501 }
2502 else
2503 {
2504 XGCValues xgcv;
2505 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2506 &xgcv);
2507 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2508 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2509 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2510 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2511 }
2512 }
2513 else
2514 {
2515 int x = s->x;
2516 int y = s->y;
2517
2518 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2519 && s->slice.x == 0)
2520 x += box_line_hwidth;
2521
2522 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2523 y += box_line_vwidth;
2524
2525 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2526 }
2527
2528 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2529 }
2530
2531 /* Draw the foreground. */
2532 if (pixmap != None)
2533 {
2534 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2535 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2536 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2537 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2538 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2539 }
2540 else
2541 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2542
2543 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2544 if (s->img->relief
2545 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2546 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2547 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2548 }
2549
2550
2551 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2552
2553 static void
2554 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2555 {
2556 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2557
2558 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2559 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2560 {
2561 /* If `x-stretch-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor as
2562 wide as the stretch glyph. */
2563 int width, background_width = s->background_width;
2564 int x = s->x;
2565
2566 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2567 {
2568 int left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2569
2570 if (x < left_x)
2571 {
2572 background_width -= left_x - x;
2573 x = left_x;
2574 }
2575 }
2576 else
2577 {
2578 /* In R2L rows, draw the cursor on the right edge of the
2579 stretch glyph. */
2580 int right_x = window_box_right_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2581
2582 if (x + background_width > right_x)
2583 background_width -= x - right_x;
2584 x += background_width;
2585 }
2586 width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), background_width);
2587 if (s->row->reversed_p)
2588 x -= width;
2589
2590 /* Draw cursor. */
2591 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, width, s->height);
2592
2593 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2594 if (width < background_width)
2595 {
2596 int y = s->y;
2597 int w = background_width - width, h = s->height;
2598 XRectangle r;
2599 GC gc;
2600
2601 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2602 x += width;
2603 else
2604 x = s->x;
2605 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2606 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2607 {
2608 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2609 gc = s->gc;
2610 }
2611 else
2612 gc = s->face->gc;
2613
2614 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2615 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2616
2617 if (s->face->stipple)
2618 {
2619 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2620 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2621 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2622 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2623 }
2624 else
2625 {
2626 XGCValues xgcv;
2627 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2628 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2629 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2630 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2631 }
2632 }
2633 }
2634 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2635 {
2636 int background_width = s->background_width;
2637 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2638
2639 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
2640 except for header line and mode line. */
2641 if (x < left_x && !s->row->mode_line_p)
2642 {
2643 background_width -= left_x - x;
2644 x = left_x;
2645 }
2646 if (background_width > 0)
2647 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, background_width, s->height);
2648 }
2649
2650 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2651 }
2652
2653
2654 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2655
2656 static void
2657 x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2658 {
2659 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2660
2661 /* If S draws into the background of its successors, draw the
2662 background of the successors first so that S can draw into it.
2663 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2664 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps)
2665 {
2666 int width;
2667 struct glyph_string *next;
2668
2669 for (width = 0, next = s->next;
2670 next && width < s->right_overhang;
2671 width += next->width, next = next->next)
2672 if (next->first_glyph->type != IMAGE_GLYPH)
2673 {
2674 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2675 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (next);
2676 if (next->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
2677 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (next);
2678 else
2679 x_draw_glyph_string_background (next, 1);
2680 next->num_clips = 0;
2681 }
2682 }
2683
2684 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2685 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2686
2687 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2688 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2689 if (!s->for_overlaps
2690 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2691 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2692 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2693
2694 {
2695 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2696 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2697 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2698 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2699 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2700 }
2701 else if (!s->clip_head /* draw_glyphs didn't specify a clip mask. */
2702 && !s->clip_tail
2703 && ((s->prev && s->prev->hl != s->hl && s->left_overhang)
2704 || (s->next && s->next->hl != s->hl && s->right_overhang)))
2705 /* We must clip just this glyph. left_overhang part has already
2706 drawn when s->prev was drawn, and right_overhang part will be
2707 drawn later when s->next is drawn. */
2708 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, s);
2709 else
2710 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2711
2712 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2713 {
2714 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2715 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2716 break;
2717
2718 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2719 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2720 break;
2721
2722 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2723 if (s->for_overlaps)
2724 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2725 else
2726 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2727 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2728 break;
2729
2730 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2731 if (s->for_overlaps || (s->cmp_from > 0
2732 && ! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic))
2733 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2734 else
2735 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2736 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2737 break;
2738
2739 case GLYPHLESS_GLYPH:
2740 if (s->for_overlaps)
2741 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2742 else
2743 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2744 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2745 break;
2746
2747 default:
2748 abort ();
2749 }
2750
2751 if (!s->for_overlaps)
2752 {
2753 /* Draw underline. */
2754 if (s->face->underline_p)
2755 {
2756 unsigned long thickness, position;
2757 int y;
2758
2759 if (s->prev && s->prev->face->underline_p)
2760 {
2761 /* We use the same underline style as the previous one. */
2762 thickness = s->prev->underline_thickness;
2763 position = s->prev->underline_position;
2764 }
2765 else
2766 {
2767 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2768 if (s->font && s->font->underline_thickness > 0)
2769 thickness = s->font->underline_thickness;
2770 else
2771 thickness = 1;
2772 if (x_underline_at_descent_line)
2773 position = (s->height - thickness) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2774 else
2775 {
2776 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2777 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2778 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2779 specs, and its default is
2780
2781 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2782 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2783
2784 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2785 && s->font && s->font->underline_position >= 0)
2786 position = s->font->underline_position;
2787 else if (s->font)
2788 position = (s->font->descent + 1) / 2;
2789 else
2790 position = underline_minimum_offset;
2791 }
2792 position = max (position, underline_minimum_offset);
2793 }
2794 /* Check the sanity of thickness and position. We should
2795 avoid drawing underline out of the current line area. */
2796 if (s->y + s->height <= s->ybase + position)
2797 position = (s->height - 1) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2798 if (s->y + s->height < s->ybase + position + thickness)
2799 thickness = (s->y + s->height) - (s->ybase + position);
2800 s->underline_thickness = thickness;
2801 s->underline_position = position;
2802 y = s->ybase + position;
2803 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2804 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2805 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2806 else
2807 {
2808 XGCValues xgcv;
2809 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2810 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2811 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2812 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2813 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2814 }
2815 }
2816
2817 /* Draw overline. */
2818 if (s->face->overline_p)
2819 {
2820 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2821
2822 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2823 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2824 s->width, h);
2825 else
2826 {
2827 XGCValues xgcv;
2828 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2829 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2830 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2831 s->width, h);
2832 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2833 }
2834 }
2835
2836 /* Draw strike-through. */
2837 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2838 {
2839 unsigned long h = 1;
2840 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2841
2842 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2843 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2844 s->width, h);
2845 else
2846 {
2847 XGCValues xgcv;
2848 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2849 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2850 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2851 s->width, h);
2852 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2853 }
2854 }
2855
2856 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2857 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2858 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2859
2860 if (s->prev)
2861 {
2862 struct glyph_string *prev;
2863
2864 for (prev = s->prev; prev; prev = prev->prev)
2865 if (prev->hl != s->hl
2866 && prev->x + prev->width + prev->right_overhang > s->x)
2867 {
2868 /* As prev was drawn while clipped to its own area, we
2869 must draw the right_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2870 enum draw_glyphs_face save = prev->hl;
2871
2872 prev->hl = s->hl;
2873 x_set_glyph_string_gc (prev);
2874 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, prev);
2875 if (prev->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2876 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2877 else
2878 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2879 XSetClipMask (prev->display, prev->gc, None);
2880 prev->hl = save;
2881 prev->num_clips = 0;
2882 }
2883 }
2884
2885 if (s->next)
2886 {
2887 struct glyph_string *next;
2888
2889 for (next = s->next; next; next = next->next)
2890 if (next->hl != s->hl
2891 && next->x - next->left_overhang < s->x + s->width)
2892 {
2893 /* As next will be drawn while clipped to its own area,
2894 we must draw the left_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2895 enum draw_glyphs_face save = next->hl;
2896
2897 next->hl = s->hl;
2898 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2899 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, next);
2900 if (next->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2901 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2902 else
2903 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2904 XSetClipMask (next->display, next->gc, None);
2905 next->hl = save;
2906 next->num_clips = 0;
2907 }
2908 }
2909 }
2910
2911 /* Reset clipping. */
2912 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2913 s->num_clips = 0;
2914 }
2915
2916 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2917
2918 static void
2919 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height, int shift_by)
2920 {
2921 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2922 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2923 x, y, width, height,
2924 x + shift_by, y);
2925 }
2926
2927 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2928 for X frames. */
2929
2930 static void
2931 x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *f, register int n)
2932 {
2933 abort ();
2934 }
2935
2936
2937 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2938 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2939
2940 void
2941 x_clear_area (Display *dpy, Window window, int x, int y, int width, int height, int exposures)
2942 {
2943 xassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
2944 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
2945 }
2946
2947
2948 /* Clear an entire frame. */
2949
2950 static void
2951 x_clear_frame (struct frame *f)
2952 {
2953 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
2954 longer visible. */
2955 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
2956 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
2957 output_cursor.x = -1;
2958
2959 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
2960 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
2961 BLOCK_INPUT;
2962
2963 /* The following call is commented out because it does not seem to accomplish
2964 anything, apart from causing flickering during window resize. */
2965 /* XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f)); */
2966
2967 /* We have to clear the scroll bars. If we have changed colors or
2968 something like that, then they should be notified. */
2969 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
2970
2971 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
2972 /* Make sure scroll bars are redrawn. As they aren't redrawn by
2973 redisplay, do it here. */
2974 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
2975 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
2976 #endif
2977
2978 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
2979
2980 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2981 }
2982
2983
2984 \f
2985 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
2986
2987 /* We use the select system call to do the waiting, so we have to make
2988 sure it's available. If it isn't, we just won't do visual bells. */
2989
2990 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
2991
2992
2993 /* Subtract the `struct timeval' values X and Y, storing the result in
2994 *RESULT. Return 1 if the difference is negative, otherwise 0. */
2995
2996 static int
2997 timeval_subtract (struct timeval *result, struct timeval x, struct timeval y)
2998 {
2999 /* Perform the carry for the later subtraction by updating y. This
3000 is safer because on some systems the tv_sec member is unsigned. */
3001 if (x.tv_usec < y.tv_usec)
3002 {
3003 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000 + 1;
3004 y.tv_usec -= 1000000 * nsec;
3005 y.tv_sec += nsec;
3006 }
3007
3008 if (x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec > 1000000)
3009 {
3010 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000;
3011 y.tv_usec += 1000000 * nsec;
3012 y.tv_sec -= nsec;
3013 }
3014
3015 /* Compute the time remaining to wait. tv_usec is certainly
3016 positive. */
3017 result->tv_sec = x.tv_sec - y.tv_sec;
3018 result->tv_usec = x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec;
3019
3020 /* Return indication of whether the result should be considered
3021 negative. */
3022 return x.tv_sec < y.tv_sec;
3023 }
3024
3025 static void
3026 XTflash (struct frame *f)
3027 {
3028 BLOCK_INPUT;
3029
3030 {
3031 #ifdef USE_GTK
3032 /* Use Gdk routines to draw. This way, we won't draw over scroll bars
3033 when the scroll bars and the edit widget share the same X window. */
3034 GdkWindow *window = gtk_widget_get_window (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
3035 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3036 cairo_t *cr = gdk_cairo_create (window);
3037 cairo_set_source_rgb (cr, 1, 1, 1);
3038 cairo_set_operator (cr, CAIRO_OPERATOR_DIFFERENCE);
3039 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3040 do { \
3041 cairo_rectangle (cr, x, y, w, h); \
3042 cairo_fill (cr); \
3043 } \
3044 while (0)
3045 #else /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3046 GdkGCValues vals;
3047 GdkGC *gc;
3048 vals.foreground.pixel = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3049 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3050 vals.function = GDK_XOR;
3051 gc = gdk_gc_new_with_values (window,
3052 &vals, GDK_GC_FUNCTION | GDK_GC_FOREGROUND);
3053 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3054 gdk_draw_rectangle (window, gc, TRUE, x, y, w, h)
3055 #endif /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3056 #else /* ! USE_GTK */
3057 GC gc;
3058
3059 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
3060 pixels into background pixels. */
3061 {
3062 XGCValues values;
3063
3064 values.function = GXxor;
3065 values.foreground = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3066 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3067
3068 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3069 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
3070 }
3071 #endif
3072 {
3073 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
3074 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
3075 /* Height of each line to flash. */
3076 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
3077 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
3078 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3079 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3080
3081 int width;
3082
3083 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
3084 edge it is next to. */
3085 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
3086 {
3087 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
3088 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3089 break;
3090
3091 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
3092 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3093 break;
3094
3095 default:
3096 break;
3097 }
3098
3099 width = flash_right - flash_left;
3100
3101 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3102 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3103 {
3104 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3105 flash_left,
3106 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3107 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3108 width, flash_height);
3109 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3110 flash_left,
3111 (height - flash_height
3112 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3113 width, flash_height);
3114
3115 }
3116 else
3117 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3118 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3119 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3120 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3121
3122 x_flush (f);
3123
3124 {
3125 struct timeval wakeup;
3126
3127 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup);
3128
3129 /* Compute time to wait until, propagating carry from usecs. */
3130 wakeup.tv_usec += 150000;
3131 wakeup.tv_sec += (wakeup.tv_usec / 1000000);
3132 wakeup.tv_usec %= 1000000;
3133
3134 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
3135 available. */
3136 while (! detect_input_pending ())
3137 {
3138 struct timeval current;
3139 struct timeval timeout;
3140
3141 EMACS_GET_TIME (current);
3142
3143 /* Break if result would be negative. */
3144 if (timeval_subtract (&current, wakeup, current))
3145 break;
3146
3147 /* How long `select' should wait. */
3148 timeout.tv_sec = 0;
3149 timeout.tv_usec = 10000;
3150
3151 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
3152 select (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout);
3153 }
3154 }
3155
3156 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3157 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3158 {
3159 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3160 flash_left,
3161 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3162 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3163 width, flash_height);
3164 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3165 flash_left,
3166 (height - flash_height
3167 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3168 width, flash_height);
3169 }
3170 else
3171 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3172 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3173 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3174 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3175
3176 #ifdef USE_GTK
3177 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3178 cairo_destroy (cr);
3179 #else
3180 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (gc));
3181 #endif
3182 #undef XFillRectangle
3183 #else
3184 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
3185 #endif
3186 x_flush (f);
3187 }
3188 }
3189
3190 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3191 }
3192
3193 #endif /* defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT) */
3194
3195
3196 static void
3197 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (FRAME_PTR f, int invisible)
3198 {
3199 BLOCK_INPUT;
3200 if (invisible)
3201 {
3202 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor != 0)
3203 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3204 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor);
3205 }
3206 else
3207 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3208 f->output_data.x->current_cursor);
3209 f->pointer_invisible = invisible;
3210 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3211 }
3212
3213
3214 /* Make audible bell. */
3215
3216 static void
3217 XTring_bell (struct frame *f)
3218 {
3219 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3220 {
3221 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
3222 if (visible_bell)
3223 XTflash (f);
3224 else
3225 #endif
3226 {
3227 BLOCK_INPUT;
3228 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3229 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3230 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3231 }
3232 }
3233 }
3234
3235 \f
3236 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3237 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3238 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3239 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3240
3241 static void
3242 XTset_terminal_window (struct frame *f, int n)
3243 {
3244 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3245 }
3246
3247
3248 \f
3249 /***********************************************************************
3250 Line Dance
3251 ***********************************************************************/
3252
3253 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3254 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3255
3256 static void
3257 x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *f, int vpos, int n)
3258 {
3259 abort ();
3260 }
3261
3262
3263 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3264
3265 static void
3266 x_scroll_run (struct window *w, struct run *run)
3267 {
3268 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3269 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3270
3271 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3272 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3273 fringe of W. */
3274 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3275
3276 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
3277 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
3278 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
3279 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
3280 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
3281 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
3282 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
3283 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
3284 {
3285 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
3286
3287 if (sb_width > 0)
3288 {
3289 int bar_area_x = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
3290 int bar_area_width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
3291 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
3292
3293 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == x)
3294 {
3295 x = bar_area_x + sb_width;
3296 width += bar_area_width - sb_width;
3297 }
3298 else if (x + width == bar_area_x)
3299 width += bar_area_width - sb_width;
3300 }
3301 }
3302 #endif
3303
3304 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3305 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3306 bottom_y = y + height;
3307
3308 if (to_y < from_y)
3309 {
3310 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3311 line at the bottom. */
3312 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3313 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3314 else
3315 height = run->height;
3316 }
3317 else
3318 {
3319 /* Scolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3320 at the bottom. */
3321 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3322 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3323 else
3324 height = run->height;
3325 }
3326
3327 BLOCK_INPUT;
3328
3329 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3330 updated_window = w;
3331 x_clear_cursor (w);
3332
3333 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3334 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3335 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3336 x, from_y,
3337 width, height,
3338 x, to_y);
3339
3340 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3341 }
3342
3343
3344 \f
3345 /***********************************************************************
3346 Exposure Events
3347 ***********************************************************************/
3348
3349 \f
3350 static void
3351 frame_highlight (struct frame *f)
3352 {
3353 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3354 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3355 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3356 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3357 BLOCK_INPUT;
3358 /* I recently started to get errors in this XSetWindowBorder, depending on
3359 the window-manager in use, tho something more is at play since I've been
3360 using that same window-manager binary for ever. Let's not crash just
3361 because of this (bug#9310). */
3362 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3363 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3364 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3365 x_uncatch_errors ();
3366 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3367 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3368 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3369 }
3370
3371 static void
3372 frame_unhighlight (struct frame *f)
3373 {
3374 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3375 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3376 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3377 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3378 BLOCK_INPUT;
3379 /* Same as above for XSetWindowBorder (bug#9310). */
3380 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3381 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3382 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3383 x_uncatch_errors ();
3384 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3385 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3386 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3387 }
3388
3389 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3390 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3391 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3392 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3393 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3394
3395 static void
3396 x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame)
3397 {
3398 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3399
3400 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3401 {
3402 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3403 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3404 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3405
3406 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3407 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3408
3409 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3410 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3411 else
3412 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3413 }
3414
3415 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3416 }
3417
3418 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3419 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3420 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3421
3422 static void
3423 x_focus_changed (int type, int state, struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame, struct input_event *bufp)
3424 {
3425 if (type == FocusIn)
3426 {
3427 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3428 {
3429 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3430 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3431
3432 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3433 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3434 if (NILP (Vterminal_frame)
3435 && CONSP (Vframe_list)
3436 && !NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3437 {
3438 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3439 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3440 }
3441 }
3442
3443 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3444
3445 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3446 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3447 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3448 #endif
3449 }
3450 else if (type == FocusOut)
3451 {
3452 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3453
3454 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3455 {
3456 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3457 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3458 }
3459
3460 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3461 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3462 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3463 #endif
3464 if (frame->pointer_invisible)
3465 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (frame, 0);
3466 }
3467 }
3468
3469 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3470 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3471
3472 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3473
3474 static void
3475 x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event, struct input_event *bufp)
3476 {
3477 struct frame *frame;
3478
3479 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3480 if (! frame)
3481 return;
3482
3483 switch (event->type)
3484 {
3485 case EnterNotify:
3486 case LeaveNotify:
3487 {
3488 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3489 int focus_state
3490 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3491
3492 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3493 && event->xcrossing.focus
3494 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3495 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3496 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3497 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3498 }
3499 break;
3500
3501 case FocusIn:
3502 case FocusOut:
3503 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3504 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3505 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3506 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3507 break;
3508
3509 case ClientMessage:
3510 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
3511 {
3512 enum xembed_message msg = event->xclient.data.l[1];
3513 x_focus_changed ((msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3514 FOCUS_EXPLICIT, dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3515 }
3516 break;
3517 }
3518 }
3519
3520
3521 #if defined HAVE_MENUS && !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
3522 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3523
3524 void
3525 x_mouse_leave (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3526 {
3527 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3528 }
3529 #endif
3530
3531 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3532 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3533 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3534
3535 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3536 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3537 the appropriate X display info. */
3538
3539 static void
3540 XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *frame)
3541 {
3542 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3543 }
3544
3545 static void
3546 x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3547 {
3548 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3549
3550 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3551 {
3552 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3553 = ((FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3554 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3555 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3556 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3557 {
3558 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame) = Qnil;
3559 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3560 }
3561 }
3562 else
3563 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3564
3565 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3566 {
3567 if (old_highlight)
3568 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3569 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3570 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3571 }
3572 }
3573
3574
3575 \f
3576 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3577
3578 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3579 static void
3580 x_find_modifier_meanings (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3581 {
3582 int min_code, max_code;
3583 KeySym *syms;
3584 int syms_per_code;
3585 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3586
3587 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3588 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3589 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3590 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3591 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3592
3593 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3594
3595 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3596 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3597 &syms_per_code);
3598 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3599
3600 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3601 Alt keysyms are on. */
3602 {
3603 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3604 int found_alt_or_meta;
3605
3606 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3607 {
3608 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3609 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3610 {
3611 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3612
3613 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3614 if (code == 0)
3615 continue;
3616
3617 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3618 {
3619 int code_col;
3620
3621 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3622 {
3623 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3624
3625 switch (sym)
3626 {
3627 case XK_Meta_L:
3628 case XK_Meta_R:
3629 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3630 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3631 break;
3632
3633 case XK_Alt_L:
3634 case XK_Alt_R:
3635 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3636 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3637 break;
3638
3639 case XK_Hyper_L:
3640 case XK_Hyper_R:
3641 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3642 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3643 code_col = syms_per_code;
3644 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3645 break;
3646
3647 case XK_Super_L:
3648 case XK_Super_R:
3649 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3650 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3651 code_col = syms_per_code;
3652 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3653 break;
3654
3655 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3656 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3657 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3658 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3659 code_col = syms_per_code;
3660 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3661 break;
3662 }
3663 }
3664 }
3665 }
3666 }
3667 }
3668
3669 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3670 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3671 {
3672 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3673 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3674 }
3675
3676 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3677 make them just meta, not alt. */
3678 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3679 {
3680 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3681 }
3682
3683 XFree ((char *) syms);
3684 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3685 }
3686
3687 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3688 Emacs uses. */
3689
3690 int
3691 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, int state)
3692 {
3693 int mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3694 int mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3695 int mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3696 int mod_super = super_modifier;
3697 Lisp_Object tem;
3698
3699 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3700 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3701 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3702 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3703 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3704 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3705 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3706 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3707
3708 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3709 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3710 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3711 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3712 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3713 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3714 }
3715
3716 static int
3717 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, EMACS_INT state)
3718 {
3719 EMACS_INT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3720 EMACS_INT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3721 EMACS_INT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3722 EMACS_INT mod_super = super_modifier;
3723
3724 Lisp_Object tem;
3725
3726 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3727 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem);
3728 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3729 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem);
3730 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3731 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem);
3732 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3733 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem);
3734
3735
3736 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3737 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3738 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3739 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3740 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3741 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3742 }
3743
3744 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3745
3746 char *
3747 x_get_keysym_name (int keysym)
3748 {
3749 char *value;
3750
3751 BLOCK_INPUT;
3752 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3753 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3754
3755 return value;
3756 }
3757
3758
3759 \f
3760 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3761
3762 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3763
3764 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3765 the mouse. */
3766
3767 static Lisp_Object
3768 construct_mouse_click (struct input_event *result, XButtonEvent *event, struct frame *f)
3769 {
3770 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3771 otherwise. */
3772 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3773 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3774 result->timestamp = event->time;
3775 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3776 event->state)
3777 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3778 ? up_modifier
3779 : down_modifier));
3780
3781 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3782 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3783 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3784 result->arg = Qnil;
3785 return Qnil;
3786 }
3787
3788 \f
3789 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3790 The input handler calls this.
3791
3792 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3793 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3794 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3795 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3796
3797 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3798 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3799
3800 static int
3801 note_mouse_movement (FRAME_PTR frame, XMotionEvent *event)
3802 {
3803 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3804 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3805 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3806
3807 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame))
3808 return 0;
3809
3810 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3811 {
3812 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3813 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3814 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3815 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
3816 return 1;
3817 }
3818
3819
3820 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3821 if (frame != last_mouse_glyph_frame
3822 || event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3823 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3824 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3825 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3826 {
3827 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3828 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3829 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3830 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3831 remember_mouse_glyph (frame, event->x, event->y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3832 last_mouse_glyph_frame = frame;
3833 return 1;
3834 }
3835
3836 return 0;
3837 }
3838
3839 \f
3840 /************************************************************************
3841 Mouse Face
3842 ************************************************************************/
3843
3844 static void
3845 redo_mouse_highlight (void)
3846 {
3847 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3848 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3849 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3850 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3851 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3852 }
3853
3854
3855
3856 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3857 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3858
3859 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3860 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3861 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3862 position on the scroll bar.
3863
3864 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3865 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3866 the mouse is over.
3867
3868 Set *TIMESTAMP to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3869 was at this position.
3870
3871 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3872
3873 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3874 movement. */
3875
3876 static void
3877 XTmouse_position (FRAME_PTR *fp, int insist, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
3878 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x, Lisp_Object *y,
3879 Time *timestamp)
3880 {
3881 FRAME_PTR f1;
3882
3883 BLOCK_INPUT;
3884
3885 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3886 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, timestamp);
3887 else
3888 {
3889 Window root;
3890 int root_x, root_y;
3891
3892 Window dummy_window;
3893 int dummy;
3894
3895 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3896
3897 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3898 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3899 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
3900 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3901 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3902
3903 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3904
3905 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3906 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3907 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3908
3909 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3910 &root,
3911
3912 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3913 a different screen. */
3914 &dummy_window,
3915
3916 /* The position on that root window. */
3917 &root_x, &root_y,
3918
3919 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3920 &dummy, &dummy,
3921
3922 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3923 we don't care. */
3924 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3925
3926 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3927 containing the pointer. */
3928 {
3929 Window win, child;
3930 int win_x, win_y;
3931 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3932
3933 win = root;
3934
3935 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3936 structure is changing at the same time this function
3937 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3938
3939 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3940
3941 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3942 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3943 {
3944 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3945 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3946 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3947
3948 /* From-window, to-window. */
3949 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3950
3951 /* From-position, to-position. */
3952 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3953
3954 /* Child of win. */
3955 &child);
3956 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3957 }
3958 else
3959 {
3960 while (1)
3961 {
3962 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3963
3964 /* From-window, to-window. */
3965 root, win,
3966
3967 /* From-position, to-position. */
3968 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3969
3970 /* Child of win. */
3971 &child);
3972
3973 if (child == None || child == win)
3974 break;
3975 #ifdef USE_GTK
3976 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3977 want the edit window. For non-Gtk+ the innermost
3978 window is the edit window. For Gtk+ it might not
3979 be. It might be the tool bar for example. */
3980 if (x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win))
3981 break;
3982 #endif
3983 win = child;
3984 parent_x = win_x;
3985 parent_y = win_y;
3986 }
3987
3988 /* Now we know that:
3989 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
3990 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
3991 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
3992 (XTC did this the last time through), and
3993 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
3994 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
3995 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
3996 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
3997 never use them in that case.) */
3998
3999 #ifdef USE_GTK
4000 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
4001 want the edit window. */
4002 f1 = x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
4003 #else
4004 /* Is win one of our frames? */
4005 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
4006 #endif
4007
4008 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4009 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
4010 on the frame. */
4011 if (f1 != NULL
4012 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
4013 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
4014 f1 = NULL;
4015 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
4016 }
4017
4018 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
4019 f1 = 0;
4020
4021 x_uncatch_errors ();
4022
4023 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
4024 if (! f1)
4025 {
4026 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4027
4028 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
4029
4030 if (bar)
4031 {
4032 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4033 win_x = parent_x;
4034 win_y = parent_y;
4035 }
4036 }
4037
4038 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
4039 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
4040
4041 if (f1)
4042 {
4043 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
4044 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
4045 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
4046 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
4047 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
4048 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
4049 the frame are divided into. */
4050
4051 remember_mouse_glyph (f1, win_x, win_y, &last_mouse_glyph);
4052 last_mouse_glyph_frame = f1;
4053
4054 *bar_window = Qnil;
4055 *part = 0;
4056 *fp = f1;
4057 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
4058 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
4059 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
4060 }
4061 }
4062 }
4063
4064 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4065 }
4066
4067
4068 \f
4069 /***********************************************************************
4070 Scroll bars
4071 ***********************************************************************/
4072
4073 /* Scroll bar support. */
4074
4075 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
4076 manages it.
4077 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
4078 bits. */
4079
4080 static struct scroll_bar *
4081 x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *display, Window window_id)
4082 {
4083 Lisp_Object tail;
4084
4085 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
4086 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
4087 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4088
4089 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
4090 {
4091 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
4092
4093 frame = XCAR (tail);
4094 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
4095 if (! FRAMEP (frame))
4096 abort ();
4097
4098 if (! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
4099 continue;
4100
4101 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
4102 right window ID. */
4103 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4104 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4105 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
4106 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
4107 ! NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
4108 condemned = Qnil,
4109 ! NILP (bar));
4110 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
4111 if (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window == window_id &&
4112 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
4113 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
4114 }
4115
4116 return NULL;
4117 }
4118
4119
4120 #if defined USE_LUCID
4121
4122 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
4123 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
4124
4125 static Widget
4126 x_window_to_menu_bar (Window window)
4127 {
4128 Lisp_Object tail;
4129
4130 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
4131 {
4132 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (XCAR (tail))))
4133 {
4134 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
4135 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
4136
4137 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
4138 return menu_bar;
4139 }
4140 }
4141
4142 return NULL;
4143 }
4144
4145 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
4146
4147 \f
4148 /************************************************************************
4149 Toolkit scroll bars
4150 ************************************************************************/
4151
4152 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4153
4154 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *, struct input_event *);
4155 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object, int, int, int);
4156 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *,
4157 struct scroll_bar *);
4158 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *,
4159 int, int, int);
4160
4161
4162 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
4163 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
4164
4165 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
4166
4167 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
4168
4169 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
4170
4171 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
4172 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
4173
4174 #ifndef USE_GTK
4175 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
4176
4177 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
4178
4179 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
4180
4181 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
4182 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
4183 to avoid jerkyness. */
4184
4185 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
4186
4187 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
4188 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
4189 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4190 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4191
4192 static void
4193 xt_action_hook (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, String action_name,
4194 XEvent *event, String *params, Cardinal *num_params)
4195 {
4196 int scroll_bar_p;
4197 const char *end_action;
4198
4199 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4200 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4201 end_action = "Release";
4202 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4203 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4204 end_action = "EndScroll";
4205 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4206
4207 if (scroll_bar_p
4208 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4209 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4210 {
4211 struct window *w;
4212
4213 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4214 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4215 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4216
4217 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4218 {
4219 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4220 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4221 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4222 }
4223 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4224 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4225
4226 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4227 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4228 }
4229 }
4230 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4231
4232 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4233 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4234
4235 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4236 static ptrdiff_t scroll_bar_windows_size;
4237
4238
4239 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4240 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4241 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4242 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4243
4244 static void
4245 x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object window, int part, int portion, int whole)
4246 {
4247 XEvent event;
4248 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4249 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4250 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4251 ptrdiff_t i;
4252
4253 BLOCK_INPUT;
4254
4255 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4256 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4257 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4258 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4259 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4260 ev->format = 32;
4261
4262 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4263 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4264 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4265 into that array in the event. */
4266 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4267 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4268 break;
4269
4270 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4271 {
4272 ptrdiff_t old_nbytes =
4273 scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4274 ptrdiff_t nbytes;
4275 enum { XClientMessageEvent_MAX = 0x7fffffff };
4276 scroll_bar_windows =
4277 xpalloc (scroll_bar_windows, &scroll_bar_windows_size, 1,
4278 XClientMessageEvent_MAX, sizeof *scroll_bar_windows);
4279 nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4280 memset (&scroll_bar_windows[i], 0, nbytes - old_nbytes);
4281 }
4282
4283 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4284 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4285 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4286 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4287 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4288 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4289
4290 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4291 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4292 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4293 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
4294 #endif
4295
4296 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4297 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4298 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4299 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4300 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4301 }
4302
4303
4304 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4305 in *IEVENT. */
4306
4307 static void
4308 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *event, struct input_event *ievent)
4309 {
4310 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4311 Lisp_Object window;
4312 struct window *w;
4313
4314 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4315 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4316
4317 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4318
4319 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4320 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4321 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4322 #ifdef USE_GTK
4323 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4324 #else
4325 ievent->timestamp =
4326 XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (w->frame)));
4327 #endif
4328 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4329 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4330 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4331 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4332 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4333 }
4334
4335
4336 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4337
4338 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4339
4340 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4341
4342
4343 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4344 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4345 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4346
4347 static void
4348 xm_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4349 {
4350 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4351 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4352 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4353
4354 switch (cs->reason)
4355 {
4356 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4357 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4358 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4359 break;
4360
4361 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4362 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4363 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4364 break;
4365
4366 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4367 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4368 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4369 break;
4370
4371 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4372 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4373 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4374 break;
4375
4376 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4377 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4378 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4379 break;
4380
4381 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4382 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4383 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4384 break;
4385
4386 case XmCR_DRAG:
4387 {
4388 int slider_size;
4389
4390 /* Get the slider size. */
4391 BLOCK_INPUT;
4392 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4393 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4394
4395 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4396 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4397 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4398 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4399 }
4400 break;
4401
4402 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4403 break;
4404 };
4405
4406 if (part >= 0)
4407 {
4408 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4409 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4410 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4411 }
4412 }
4413
4414 #elif defined USE_GTK
4415
4416 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4417 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4418
4419 static gboolean
4420 xg_scroll_callback (GtkRange *range,
4421 GtkScrollType scroll,
4422 gdouble value,
4423 gpointer user_data)
4424 {
4425 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4426 gdouble position;
4427 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4428 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (range));
4429 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (range), XG_FRAME_DATA);
4430
4431 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return FALSE;
4432 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4433
4434
4435 switch (scroll)
4436 {
4437 case GTK_SCROLL_JUMP:
4438 /* Buttons 1 2 or 3 must be grabbed. */
4439 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed != 0
4440 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed < (1 << 4))
4441 {
4442 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4443 whole = gtk_adjustment_get_upper (adj) -
4444 gtk_adjustment_get_page_size (adj);
4445 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4446 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4447 }
4448 break;
4449 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_BACKWARD:
4450 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4451 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4452 break;
4453 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_FORWARD:
4454 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4455 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4456 break;
4457 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_BACKWARD:
4458 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4459 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4460 break;
4461 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_FORWARD:
4462 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4463 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4464 break;
4465 }
4466
4467 if (part >= 0)
4468 {
4469 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4470 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4471 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4472 }
4473
4474 return FALSE;
4475 }
4476
4477 /* Callback for button release. Sets dragging to Qnil when dragging is done. */
4478
4479 static gboolean
4480 xg_end_scroll_callback (GtkWidget *widget,
4481 GdkEventButton *event,
4482 gpointer user_data)
4483 {
4484 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4485 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4486 if (WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4487 {
4488 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4489 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4490 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4491 }
4492
4493 return FALSE;
4494 }
4495
4496
4497 #else /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4498
4499 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4500 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4501 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4502 the thumb is. */
4503
4504 static void
4505 xaw_jump_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4506 {
4507 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4508 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4509 float shown;
4510 int whole, portion, height;
4511 int part;
4512
4513 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4514 BLOCK_INPUT;
4515 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4516 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4517
4518 whole = 10000000;
4519 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4520
4521 if (shown < 1 && (eabs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0/height))
4522 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4523 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4524 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4525 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4526 bottom). */
4527 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4528 else
4529 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4530
4531 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4532 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4533 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4534 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4535 }
4536
4537
4538 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4539 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4540 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4541 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4542 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4543 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4544 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4545
4546 static void
4547 xaw_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4548 {
4549 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4550 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4551 int position = (long) call_data;
4552 Dimension height;
4553 int part;
4554
4555 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4556 BLOCK_INPUT;
4557 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4558 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4559
4560 if (eabs (position) >= height)
4561 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4562
4563 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4564 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4565 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && eabs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4566 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4567 else
4568 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4569
4570 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4571 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4572 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4573 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4574 }
4575
4576 #endif /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4577
4578 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4579
4580 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4581 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4582
4583 #ifdef USE_GTK
4584 static void
4585 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4586 {
4587 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4588
4589 BLOCK_INPUT;
4590 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4591 G_CALLBACK (xg_end_scroll_callback),
4592 scroll_bar_name);
4593 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4594 }
4595
4596 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4597
4598 static void
4599 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4600 {
4601 Window xwindow;
4602 Widget widget;
4603 Arg av[20];
4604 int ac = 0;
4605 char const *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4606 unsigned long pixel;
4607
4608 BLOCK_INPUT;
4609
4610 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4611 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4612 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4613 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4614 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4615 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4616 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4617 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4618 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4619
4620 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4621 if (pixel != -1)
4622 {
4623 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4624 ++ac;
4625 }
4626
4627 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4628 if (pixel != -1)
4629 {
4630 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4631 ++ac;
4632 }
4633
4634 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4635 scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4636
4637 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4638 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4639 (XtPointer) bar);
4640 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4641 (XtPointer) bar);
4642 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4643 (XtPointer) bar);
4644 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4645 (XtPointer) bar);
4646 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4647 (XtPointer) bar);
4648 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4649 (XtPointer) bar);
4650 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4651 (XtPointer) bar);
4652
4653 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4654 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4655
4656 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4657 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4658 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4659 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4660
4661 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4662
4663 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4664 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4665 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4666 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4667 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4668 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4669 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4670 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4671
4672 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4673 if (pixel != -1)
4674 {
4675 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4676 ++ac;
4677 }
4678
4679 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4680 if (pixel != -1)
4681 {
4682 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4683 ++ac;
4684 }
4685
4686 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4687
4688 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4689 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4690 {
4691 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4692 if (pixel != -1)
4693 {
4694 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4695 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4696 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4697 pixel = -1;
4698 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4699 }
4700 }
4701 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4702 {
4703 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4704 if (pixel != -1)
4705 {
4706 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4707 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4708 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4709 pixel = -1;
4710 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4711 }
4712 }
4713
4714 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4715 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4716 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4717 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4718 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4719 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4720 /* But only if we have a small colormap. Xaw3d can allocate nice
4721 colors itself. */
4722 {
4723 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap,
4724 DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f)) < 16);
4725 ++ac;
4726 }
4727 else
4728 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4729 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4730 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4731 {
4732 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4733 the shadows. */
4734 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4735 ++ac;
4736
4737 /* Specify the colors. */
4738 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4739 if (pixel != -1)
4740 {
4741 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
4742 ++ac;
4743 }
4744 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4745 if (pixel != -1)
4746 {
4747 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
4748 ++ac;
4749 }
4750 }
4751 #endif
4752
4753 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4754 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4755
4756 {
4757 char const *initial = "";
4758 char const *val = initial;
4759 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4760 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4761 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
4762 #endif
4763 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4764 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
4765 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4766 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4767 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4768 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4769 }
4770 }
4771
4772 /* Define callbacks. */
4773 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4774 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4775 (XtPointer) bar);
4776
4777 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4778 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4779
4780 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4781
4782 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4783 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4784 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4785 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4786
4787 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4788 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4789 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4790 bar->x_window = xwindow;
4791
4792 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4793 }
4794 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4795
4796
4797 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4798 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4799
4800 #ifdef USE_GTK
4801 static void
4802 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position, int whole)
4803 {
4804 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4805 }
4806
4807 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4808 static void
4809 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position,
4810 int whole)
4811 {
4812 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4813 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4814 float top, shown;
4815
4816 BLOCK_INPUT;
4817
4818 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4819
4820 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4821 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4822 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4823 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4824 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4825 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4826 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4827 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4828 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4829 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4830 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4831 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4832 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4833 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4834 whole += portion;
4835
4836 if (whole <= 0)
4837 top = 0, shown = 1;
4838 else
4839 {
4840 top = (float) position / whole;
4841 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4842 }
4843
4844 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4845 {
4846 int size, value;
4847
4848 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4849 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4850 value. */
4851 size = shown * XM_SB_MAX;
4852 size = min (size, XM_SB_MAX);
4853 size = max (size, 1);
4854
4855 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4856 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4857 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4858
4859 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4860 }
4861 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4862
4863 if (whole == 0)
4864 top = 0, shown = 1;
4865 else
4866 {
4867 top = (float) position / whole;
4868 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4869 }
4870
4871 {
4872 float old_top, old_shown;
4873 Dimension height;
4874 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4875 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4876 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4877 XtNheight, &height,
4878 NULL);
4879
4880 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4881 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4882 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4883 else
4884 top = old_top;
4885 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4886 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0 / height), shown));
4887
4888 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4889 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4890 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4891 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4892 {
4893 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4894 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4895 else
4896 {
4897 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4898 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4899 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4900
4901 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4902 }
4903 }
4904 }
4905 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4906
4907 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4908 }
4909 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4910
4911 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4912
4913
4914 \f
4915 /************************************************************************
4916 Scroll bars, general
4917 ************************************************************************/
4918
4919 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4920 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4921 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4922 scroll bar. */
4923
4924 static struct scroll_bar *
4925 x_scroll_bar_create (struct window *w, int top, int left, int width, int height)
4926 {
4927 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4928 struct scroll_bar *bar
4929 = ALLOCATE_PSEUDOVECTOR (struct scroll_bar, x_window, PVEC_OTHER);
4930
4931 BLOCK_INPUT;
4932
4933 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4934 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4935 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4936 {
4937 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4938 unsigned long mask;
4939 Window window;
4940
4941 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4942 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4943 a.background_pixel = FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f);
4944
4945 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4946 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4947 | ExposureMask);
4948 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4949
4950 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4951
4952 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4953 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4954 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4955 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4956 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4957 left, top, width,
4958 window_box_height (w), False);
4959
4960 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4961 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4962 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4963 top,
4964 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4965 height,
4966 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4967 0,
4968 CopyFromParent,
4969 CopyFromParent,
4970 CopyFromParent,
4971 /* Attributes. */
4972 mask, &a);
4973 bar->x_window = window;
4974 }
4975 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4976
4977 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4978 bar->top = top;
4979 bar->left = left;
4980 bar->width = width;
4981 bar->height = height;
4982 bar->start = 0;
4983 bar->end = 0;
4984 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4985 bar->fringe_extended_p = 0;
4986
4987 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4988 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
4989 bar->prev = Qnil;
4990 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
4991 if (!NILP (bar->next))
4992 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
4993
4994 /* Map the window/widget. */
4995 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4996 {
4997 #ifdef USE_GTK
4998 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
4999 bar->x_window,
5000 top,
5001 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5002 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5003 max (height, 1));
5004 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5005 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
5006 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
5007 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5008 top,
5009 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5010 max (height, 1), 0);
5011 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
5012 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5013 }
5014 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5015 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5016 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5017
5018 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5019 return bar;
5020 }
5021
5022
5023 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5024
5025 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
5026
5027 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
5028 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
5029 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
5030 events.)
5031
5032 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
5033 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
5034 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
5035 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
5036 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
5037
5038 static void
5039 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (struct scroll_bar *bar, int start, int end, int rebuild)
5040 {
5041 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
5042 Window w = bar->x_window;
5043 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5044 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5045
5046 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
5047 if (! rebuild
5048 && start == bar->start
5049 && end == bar->end)
5050 return;
5051
5052 BLOCK_INPUT;
5053
5054 {
5055 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, bar->width);
5056 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, bar->height);
5057 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5058
5059 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
5060 the distance between start and end. */
5061 {
5062 int length = end - start;
5063
5064 if (start < 0)
5065 start = 0;
5066 else if (start > top_range)
5067 start = top_range;
5068 end = start + length;
5069
5070 if (end < start)
5071 end = start;
5072 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
5073 end = top_range;
5074 }
5075
5076 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
5077 bar->start = start;
5078 bar->end = end;
5079
5080 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
5081 if (end > top_range)
5082 end = top_range;
5083
5084 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
5085 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
5086 that many pixels tall. */
5087 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
5088
5089 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
5090 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5091 if (0 < start)
5092 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5093 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5094 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5095 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
5096 inside_width, start,
5097 False);
5098
5099 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
5100 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5101 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5102 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5103
5104 /* Draw the handle itself. */
5105 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5106 /* x, y, width, height */
5107 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5108 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
5109 inside_width, end - start);
5110
5111 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5112 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5113 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5114 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5115
5116 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
5117 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5118 if (end < inside_height)
5119 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5120 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5121 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5122 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
5123 inside_width, inside_height - end,
5124 False);
5125
5126 }
5127
5128 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5129 }
5130
5131 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5132
5133 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
5134 nil. */
5135
5136 static void
5137 x_scroll_bar_remove (struct scroll_bar *bar)
5138 {
5139 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5140 BLOCK_INPUT;
5141
5142 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5143 #ifdef USE_GTK
5144 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, bar->x_window);
5145 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5146 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
5147 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5148 #else
5149 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5150 #endif
5151
5152 /* Disassociate this scroll bar from its window. */
5153 XWINDOW (bar->window)->vertical_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5154
5155 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5156 }
5157
5158
5159 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
5160 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
5161 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
5162 create one. */
5163
5164 static void
5165 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (struct window *w, int portion, int whole, int position)
5166 {
5167 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5168 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5169 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
5170 int window_y, window_height;
5171 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5172 int fringe_extended_p;
5173 #endif
5174
5175 /* Get window dimensions. */
5176 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
5177 top = window_y;
5178 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5179 height = window_height;
5180
5181 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
5182 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
5183
5184 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
5185 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
5186 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
5187 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
5188 else
5189 sb_width = width;
5190
5191 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5192 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5193 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5194 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w) ? width - sb_width : 0);
5195 else
5196 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w) ? 0 : width - sb_width);
5197 #else
5198 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5199 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
5200 else
5201 sb_left = left;
5202 #endif
5203
5204 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5205 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5206 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
5207 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5208 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5209 || WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5210 else
5211 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
5212 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5213 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5214 || WINDOW_RIGHT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5215 #endif
5216
5217 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5218 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
5219 {
5220 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5221 {
5222 BLOCK_INPUT;
5223 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5224 if (fringe_extended_p)
5225 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5226 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5227 else
5228 #endif
5229 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5230 left, top, width, height, False);
5231 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5232 }
5233
5234 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5235 }
5236 else
5237 {
5238 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5239 unsigned int mask = 0;
5240
5241 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5242
5243 BLOCK_INPUT;
5244
5245 if (sb_left != bar->left)
5246 mask |= CWX;
5247 if (top != bar->top)
5248 mask |= CWY;
5249 if (sb_width != bar->width)
5250 mask |= CWWidth;
5251 if (height != bar->height)
5252 mask |= CWHeight;
5253
5254 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5255
5256 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5257 if (mask || bar->fringe_extended_p != fringe_extended_p)
5258 {
5259 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5260 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5261 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5262 {
5263 if (fringe_extended_p)
5264 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5265 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5266 else
5267 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5268 left, top, width, height, False);
5269 }
5270 #ifdef USE_GTK
5271 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5272 bar->x_window,
5273 top,
5274 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5275 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5276 max (height, 1));
5277 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5278 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5279 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5280 top,
5281 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5282 max (height, 1), 0);
5283 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5284 }
5285 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5286
5287 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5288 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5289 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5290 {
5291 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5292 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5293 height, False);
5294 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5295 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5296 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5297 height, False);
5298 }
5299
5300 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5301 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5302 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5303 example. */
5304 {
5305 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5306 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5307 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5308 {
5309 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5310 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5311 left + area_width - rest, top,
5312 rest, height, False);
5313 else
5314 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5315 left, top, rest, height, False);
5316 }
5317 }
5318
5319 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5320 if (mask)
5321 {
5322 XWindowChanges wc;
5323
5324 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5325 wc.y = top;
5326 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5327 wc.height = height;
5328 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window,
5329 mask, &wc);
5330 }
5331
5332 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5333
5334 /* Remember new settings. */
5335 bar->left = sb_left;
5336 bar->top = top;
5337 bar->width = sb_width;
5338 bar->height = height;
5339
5340 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5341 }
5342
5343 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5344 bar->fringe_extended_p = fringe_extended_p;
5345
5346 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5347 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5348 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5349 dragged. */
5350 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5351 {
5352 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5353
5354 if (whole == 0)
5355 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5356 else
5357 {
5358 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5359 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5360 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5361 }
5362 }
5363 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5364
5365 XSETVECTOR (w->vertical_scroll_bar, bar);
5366 }
5367
5368
5369 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5370 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5371 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5372 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5373 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5374 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5375 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5376
5377 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5378 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5379 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5380
5381 static void
5382 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR frame)
5383 {
5384 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5385 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5386 {
5387 Lisp_Object bar;
5388 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5389 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
5390 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5391 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5392 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5393 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5394 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = bar;
5395 }
5396 }
5397
5398
5399 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5400 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5401
5402 static void
5403 XTredeem_scroll_bar (struct window *window)
5404 {
5405 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5406 struct frame *f;
5407
5408 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5409 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5410 abort ();
5411
5412 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5413
5414 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5415 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5416 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5417 {
5418 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5419 the lists. */
5420 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5421 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5422 return;
5423 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5424 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5425 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = bar->next;
5426 else
5427 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5428 one or the other! */
5429 abort ();
5430 }
5431 else
5432 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5433
5434 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5435 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5436
5437 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5438 bar->prev = Qnil;
5439 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
5440 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5441 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5442 }
5443
5444 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5445 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5446
5447 static void
5448 XTjudge_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR f)
5449 {
5450 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5451
5452 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5453
5454 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5455 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5456 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = Qnil;
5457
5458 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5459 {
5460 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5461
5462 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5463
5464 next = b->next;
5465 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5466 }
5467
5468 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5469 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5470 }
5471
5472
5473 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5474 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5475 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5476
5477 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5478 mark bits. */
5479
5480 static void
5481 x_scroll_bar_expose (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5482 {
5483 Window w = bar->x_window;
5484 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5485 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5486 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5487
5488 BLOCK_INPUT;
5489
5490 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, bar->start, bar->end, 1);
5491
5492 /* Switch to scroll bar foreground color. */
5493 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5494 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5495 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5496
5497 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5498 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5499
5500 /* x, y, width, height */
5501 0, 0,
5502 bar->width - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5503 bar->height - 1);
5504
5505 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5506 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5507 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5508 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5509
5510 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5511
5512 }
5513 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5514
5515 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5516 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5517
5518 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5519 mark bits. */
5520
5521
5522 static void
5523 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event, struct input_event *emacs_event)
5524 {
5525 if (! WINDOWP (bar->window))
5526 abort ();
5527
5528 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5529 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5530 emacs_event->modifiers
5531 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5532 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5533 event->xbutton.state)
5534 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5535 ? up_modifier
5536 : down_modifier));
5537 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5538 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5539 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5540 {
5541 int top_range
5542 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5543 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5544
5545 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5546 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5547
5548 if (y < bar->start)
5549 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5550 else if (y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5551 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5552 else
5553 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5554
5555 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5556 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5557 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5558 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5559 {
5560 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5561 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5562
5563 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5564 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5565 }
5566 #endif
5567
5568 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5569 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5570 }
5571 }
5572
5573 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5574
5575 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5576
5577 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5578 mark bits. */
5579
5580 static void
5581 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5582 {
5583 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5584
5585 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5586
5587 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5588 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5589
5590 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5591 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5592 {
5593 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5594 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5595
5596 if (new_start != bar->start)
5597 {
5598 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5599
5600 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5601 }
5602 }
5603 }
5604
5605 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5606
5607 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5608 on the scroll bar. */
5609
5610 static void
5611 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (FRAME_PTR *fp, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
5612 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x,
5613 Lisp_Object *y, Time *timestamp)
5614 {
5615 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5616 Window w = bar->x_window;
5617 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5618 int win_x, win_y;
5619 Window dummy_window;
5620 int dummy_coord;
5621 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5622
5623 BLOCK_INPUT;
5624
5625 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5626 report that. */
5627 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5628
5629 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5630 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5631 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5632
5633 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5634 &win_x, &win_y,
5635
5636 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5637 &dummy_mask))
5638 ;
5639 else
5640 {
5641 int top_range
5642 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5643
5644 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5645
5646 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5647 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5648
5649 if (win_y < 0)
5650 win_y = 0;
5651 if (win_y > top_range)
5652 win_y = top_range;
5653
5654 *fp = f;
5655 *bar_window = bar->window;
5656
5657 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5658 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5659 else if (win_y < bar->start)
5660 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5661 else if (win_y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5662 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5663 else
5664 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5665
5666 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5667 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5668
5669 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5670 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5671 }
5672
5673 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
5674
5675 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5676 }
5677
5678
5679 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5680 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5681 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5682 redraw them. */
5683
5684 static void
5685 x_scroll_bar_clear (FRAME_PTR f)
5686 {
5687 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5688 Lisp_Object bar;
5689
5690 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5691 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5692 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5693 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5694 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5695 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5696 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5697 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window,
5698 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5699 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5700 }
5701
5702 \f
5703 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5704
5705 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5706 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5707 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5708 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5709
5710 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5711 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5712
5713 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5714
5715 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5716 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5717
5718 static int temp_index;
5719 static short temp_buffer[100];
5720
5721 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5722 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5723 temp_index = 0; \
5724 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5725
5726 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5727 on a particular display. */
5728
5729 static struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5730
5731 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5732 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5733 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5734 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5735
5736 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5737
5738 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || defined USE_GTK
5739 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT \
5740 do \
5741 { \
5742 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5743 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event \
5744 = (XEvent *) xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5745 *f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = event; \
5746 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5747 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5748 } \
5749 while (0)
5750 #endif
5751
5752 enum
5753 {
5754 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5755 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5756 X_EVENT_DROP
5757 };
5758
5759 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5760 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5761 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5762
5763 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5764 this event further.
5765 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5766
5767 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5768 static int
5769 x_filter_event (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event)
5770 {
5771 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5772 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5773 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5774 was created. */
5775
5776 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5777 event->xclient.window);
5778
5779 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5780 }
5781 #endif
5782
5783 #ifdef USE_GTK
5784 static int current_count;
5785 static int current_finish;
5786 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5787
5788 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5789 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5790 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5791 static GdkFilterReturn
5792 event_handler_gdk (GdkXEvent *gxev, GdkEvent *ev, gpointer data)
5793 {
5794 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5795
5796 BLOCK_INPUT;
5797 if (current_count >= 0)
5798 {
5799 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5800
5801 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5802
5803 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5804 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5805 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5806 so we do it here. */
5807 if ((xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5808 && dpyinfo
5809 && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5810 {
5811 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5812 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5813 }
5814 #endif
5815
5816 if (! dpyinfo)
5817 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5818 else
5819 current_count +=
5820 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5821 current_hold_quit);
5822 }
5823 else
5824 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5825
5826 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5827
5828 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5829 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5830
5831 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5832 }
5833 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5834
5835
5836 static void xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time,
5837 enum xembed_message,
5838 long detail, long data1, long data2);
5839
5840 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5841
5842 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5843 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5844 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5845
5846 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5847
5848 static int
5849 handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *eventptr,
5850 int *finish, struct input_event *hold_quit)
5851 {
5852 union {
5853 struct input_event ie;
5854 struct selection_input_event sie;
5855 } inev;
5856 int count = 0;
5857 int do_help = 0;
5858 ptrdiff_t nbytes = 0;
5859 struct frame *f = NULL;
5860 struct coding_system coding;
5861 XEvent event = *eventptr;
5862 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
5863 USE_SAFE_ALLOCA;
5864
5865 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5866
5867 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
5868 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
5869 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
5870
5871 if (pending_event_wait.eventtype == event.type)
5872 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0; /* Indicates we got it. */
5873
5874 switch (event.type)
5875 {
5876 case ClientMessage:
5877 {
5878 if (event.xclient.message_type
5879 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5880 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5881 {
5882 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5883 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5884 {
5885 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5886 could be the shell widget window
5887 if the frame has no title bar. */
5888 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5889 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5890 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5891 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5892 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5893 #endif
5894 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5895 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5896 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5897 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5898 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5899 needed.
5900
5901 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5902 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5903 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5904 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5905 Emacs. */
5906
5907 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5908 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5909 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5910 if (f)
5911 {
5912 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5913 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5914 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5915 x_catch_errors (d);
5916 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5917 /* The ICCCM says this is
5918 the only valid choice. */
5919 RevertToParent,
5920 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5921 /* This is needed to detect the error
5922 if there is an error. */
5923 XSync (d, False);
5924 x_uncatch_errors ();
5925 }
5926 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5927 #endif /* 0 */
5928 goto done;
5929 }
5930
5931 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5932 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5933 {
5934 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5935 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5936 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5937 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5938 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5939 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5940 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5941 session manager and one for this. */
5942 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5943 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5944 #endif
5945 {
5946 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5947 event.xclient.window);
5948 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5949 for a single Emacs process. */
5950 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5951 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5952 event.xclient.window,
5953 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5954 else if (f)
5955 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5956 event.xclient.window,
5957 0, 0);
5958 }
5959 goto done;
5960 }
5961
5962 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5963 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5964 {
5965 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5966 event.xclient.window);
5967 if (!f)
5968 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5969
5970 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5971 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
5972 goto done;
5973 }
5974
5975 goto done;
5976 }
5977
5978 if (event.xclient.message_type
5979 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
5980 {
5981 goto done;
5982 }
5983
5984 if (event.xclient.message_type
5985 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
5986 {
5987 int new_x, new_y;
5988 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5989
5990 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
5991 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
5992
5993 if (f)
5994 {
5995 f->left_pos = new_x;
5996 f->top_pos = new_y;
5997 }
5998 goto done;
5999 }
6000
6001 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
6002 if (event.xclient.message_type
6003 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
6004 {
6005 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6006 if (f)
6007 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
6008 &event, NULL);
6009 goto done;
6010 }
6011 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
6012
6013 if ((event.xclient.message_type
6014 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
6015 || (event.xclient.message_type
6016 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
6017 {
6018 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
6019 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
6020 currently never do because we are interested in
6021 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
6022 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
6023 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6024 if (!f)
6025 goto OTHER;
6026 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
6027 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
6028 goto done;
6029 }
6030
6031 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6032 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
6033 we construct an input_event. */
6034 if (event.xclient.message_type
6035 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
6036 {
6037 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev.ie);
6038 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6039 goto done;
6040 }
6041 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6042
6043 /* XEmbed messages from the embedder (if any). */
6044 if (event.xclient.message_type
6045 == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
6046 {
6047 enum xembed_message msg = event.xclient.data.l[1];
6048 if (msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN || msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT)
6049 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6050
6051 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6052 goto done;
6053 }
6054
6055 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6056
6057 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6058 if (!f)
6059 goto OTHER;
6060 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
6061 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6062 }
6063 break;
6064
6065 case SelectionNotify:
6066 last_user_time = event.xselection.time;
6067 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6068 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
6069 goto OTHER;
6070 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6071 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
6072 break;
6073
6074 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
6075 last_user_time = event.xselectionclear.time;
6076 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6077 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
6078 goto OTHER;
6079 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6080 {
6081 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = &(event.xselectionclear);
6082
6083 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
6084 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6085 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6086 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6087 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6088 }
6089 break;
6090
6091 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
6092 last_user_time = event.xselectionrequest.time;
6093 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6094 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
6095 goto OTHER;
6096 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6097 {
6098 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp = &(event.xselectionrequest);
6099
6100 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
6101 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6102 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
6103 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6104 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
6105 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
6106 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6107 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6108 }
6109 break;
6110
6111 case PropertyNotify:
6112 last_user_time = event.xproperty.time;
6113 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window);
6114 if (f && event.xproperty.atom == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state)
6115 x_handle_net_wm_state (f, &event.xproperty);
6116
6117 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
6118 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6119 goto OTHER;
6120
6121 case ReparentNotify:
6122 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
6123 if (f)
6124 {
6125 int x, y;
6126 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
6127 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
6128 f->left_pos = x;
6129 f->top_pos = y;
6130
6131 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
6132 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
6133 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->net_supported_window = 0;
6134
6135 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
6136 }
6137 goto OTHER;
6138
6139 case Expose:
6140 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
6141 if (f)
6142 {
6143 #ifdef USE_GTK
6144 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
6145 x_clear_area (event.xexpose.display,
6146 event.xexpose.window,
6147 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6148 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height,
6149 FALSE);
6150 #endif
6151 if (f->async_visible == 0)
6152 {
6153 f->async_visible = 1;
6154 f->async_iconified = 0;
6155 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6156 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6157 }
6158 else
6159 expose_frame (f,
6160 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6161 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
6162 }
6163 else
6164 {
6165 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6166 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6167 #endif
6168 #if defined USE_LUCID
6169 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6170 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6171 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6172 {
6173 Widget widget
6174 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6175 if (widget)
6176 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6177 }
6178 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6179
6180 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6181 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6182 goto OTHER;
6183 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6184 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
6185 event.xexpose.window);
6186
6187 if (bar)
6188 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
6189 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6190 else
6191 goto OTHER;
6192 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6193 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6194 }
6195 break;
6196
6197 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6198 source area was obscured or not
6199 available. */
6200 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6201 if (f)
6202 {
6203 expose_frame (f,
6204 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6205 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6206 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6207 }
6208 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6209 else
6210 goto OTHER;
6211 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6212 break;
6213
6214 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6215 source area was completely
6216 available. */
6217 break;
6218
6219 case UnmapNotify:
6220 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6221 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6222 {
6223 tip_window = 0;
6224 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6225 }
6226
6227 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6228 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6229 the frame was deleted. */
6230 {
6231 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6232 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6233 display that won't ever be seen. */
6234 f->async_visible = 0;
6235 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6236 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6237 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6238 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6239 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6240 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6241 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6242 {
6243 f->async_iconified = 1;
6244
6245 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6246 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6247 }
6248 }
6249 goto OTHER;
6250
6251 case MapNotify:
6252 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6253 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6254 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6255 goto OTHER;
6256
6257 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6258 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6259 frame is visible. */
6260 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6261 if (f)
6262 {
6263 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6264 the frame's display structures.
6265 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6266 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6267 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6268 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6269 if (! f->async_iconified)
6270 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6271
6272 /* Check if fullscreen was specified before we where mapped the
6273 first time, i.e. from the command line. */
6274 if (!f->output_data.x->has_been_visible)
6275 x_check_fullscreen (f);
6276
6277 f->async_visible = 1;
6278 f->async_iconified = 0;
6279 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6280
6281 if (f->iconified)
6282 {
6283 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6284 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6285 }
6286 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6287 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6288 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6289 to update the frame titles
6290 in case this is the second frame. */
6291 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6292
6293 #ifdef USE_GTK
6294 xg_frame_resized (f, -1, -1);
6295 #endif
6296 }
6297 goto OTHER;
6298
6299 case KeyPress:
6300
6301 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6302 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6303
6304 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6305 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6306 if (popup_activated ())
6307 goto OTHER;
6308 #endif
6309
6310 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6311
6312 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
6313 mouse highlighting. */
6314 if (!hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight)
6315 && (f == 0
6316 || !EQ (f->tool_bar_window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)))
6317 {
6318 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6319 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6320 }
6321
6322 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6323 if (f == 0)
6324 {
6325 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6326 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6327 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6328 event.xkey.window);
6329 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6330 {
6331 widget = XtParent (widget);
6332 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6333 }
6334 }
6335 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6336
6337 if (f != 0)
6338 {
6339 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6340 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6341 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6342 his Emacs hang.
6343
6344 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6345 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6346 status_return even if the input is too long to
6347 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6348 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6349 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6350 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6351 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6352 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6353 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6354 int modifiers;
6355 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6356 Lisp_Object c;
6357
6358 #ifdef USE_GTK
6359 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6360 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6361 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6362 (see above). */
6363 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6364 #endif
6365
6366 event.xkey.state
6367 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6368 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6369 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6370
6371 /* This will have to go some day... */
6372
6373 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6374 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6375 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6376 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6377 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6378 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6379 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6380
6381 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6382 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6383 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6384 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6385 not it is combined with Meta. */
6386 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6387 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6388
6389 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6390 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6391 {
6392 Status status_return;
6393
6394 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6395 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6396 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6397 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6398 &status_return);
6399 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6400 {
6401 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6402 copy_bufptr = (unsigned char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6403 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6404 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6405 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6406 &status_return);
6407 }
6408 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6409 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6410 break;
6411 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6412 {
6413 keysym = NoSymbol;
6414 modifiers = 0;
6415 }
6416 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6417 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6418 abort ();
6419 }
6420 else
6421 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6422 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6423 &compose_status);
6424 #else
6425 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6426 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6427 &compose_status);
6428 #endif
6429
6430 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6431 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6432 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6433 break;
6434
6435 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6436 orig_keysym = keysym;
6437
6438 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6439 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6440 inev.ie.modifiers
6441 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6442 inev.ie.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6443
6444 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6445 translations to characters. */
6446 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6447 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6448 {
6449 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6450 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6451 goto done_keysym;
6452 }
6453
6454 /* Keysyms directly mapped to Unicode characters. */
6455 if (keysym >= 0x01000000 && keysym <= 0x0110FFFF)
6456 {
6457 if (keysym < 0x01000080)
6458 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6459 else
6460 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6461 inev.ie.code = keysym & 0xFFFFFF;
6462 goto done_keysym;
6463 }
6464
6465 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6466 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6467 && (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6468 Vx_keysym_table,
6469 Qnil),
6470 NATNUMP (c)))
6471 {
6472 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6473 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6474 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6475 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
6476 goto done_keysym;
6477 }
6478
6479 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6480 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6481 || keysym == XK_Delete
6482 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6483 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6484 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6485 #endif
6486 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6487 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6488 #ifdef HPUX
6489 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6490 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6491 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6492 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6493 || (XK_Select <= keysym && keysym < XK_KP_Space)
6494 #endif
6495 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6496 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6497 #endif
6498 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6499 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6500 #endif
6501 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6502 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6503 #endif
6504 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6505 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6506 #endif
6507 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6508 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6509 #endif
6510 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6511 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6512 #endif
6513 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6514 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6515 #endif
6516 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6517 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6518 #endif
6519 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6520 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6521 #endif
6522 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6523 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6524 #endif
6525 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6526 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6527 #endif
6528 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6529 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6530 #endif
6531 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6532 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6533 #endif
6534 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6535 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6536 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6537 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6538 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6539 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6540 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6541 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6542 don't have real modifiers but
6543 should be treated similarly to
6544 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6545 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6546 || (XK_ISO_Lock <= orig_keysym
6547 && orig_keysym <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6548 #endif
6549 ))
6550 {
6551 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6552 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6553 key. */
6554 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6555 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6556 goto done_keysym;
6557 }
6558
6559 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6560 ptrdiff_t i;
6561 int nchars, len;
6562
6563 for (i = 0, nchars = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6564 {
6565 if (ASCII_BYTE_P (copy_bufptr[i]))
6566 nchars++;
6567 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6568 }
6569
6570 if (nchars < nbytes)
6571 {
6572 /* Decode the input data. */
6573
6574 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6575 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6576 we used just above and the locale. */
6577 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6578 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6579 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6580 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6581 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6582 gives us composition information. */
6583 coding.common_flags &= ~CODING_ANNOTATION_MASK;
6584
6585 SAFE_NALLOCA (coding.destination, MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH,
6586 nbytes);
6587 coding.dst_bytes = MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH * nbytes;
6588 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6589 decode_coding_c_string (&coding, copy_bufptr, nbytes, Qnil);
6590 nbytes = coding.produced;
6591 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6592 copy_bufptr = coding.destination;
6593 }
6594
6595 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6596 character events. */
6597 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6598 {
6599 int ch;
6600 if (nchars == nbytes)
6601 ch = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6602 else
6603 ch = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i, len);
6604 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (ch)
6605 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6606 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6607 inev.ie.code = ch;
6608 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6609 }
6610
6611 count += nchars;
6612
6613 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6614
6615 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6616 break;
6617 }
6618 }
6619 done_keysym:
6620 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6621 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6622 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6623 client. */
6624 break;
6625 #else
6626 goto OTHER;
6627 #endif
6628
6629 case KeyRelease:
6630 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6631 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6632 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6633 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6634 client. */
6635 break;
6636 #else
6637 goto OTHER;
6638 #endif
6639
6640 case EnterNotify:
6641 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6642 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6643
6644 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6645
6646 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6647 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6648
6649 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6650 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6651 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6652 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6653 #ifdef USE_GTK
6654 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
6655 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
6656 if (!f && last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6657 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6658 #endif
6659 goto OTHER;
6660
6661 case FocusIn:
6662 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6663 goto OTHER;
6664
6665 case LeaveNotify:
6666 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6667 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6668
6669 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6670 if (f)
6671 {
6672 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6673 {
6674 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6675 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6676 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6677 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6678 }
6679
6680 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6681 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6682 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6683 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6684 if (any_help_event_p)
6685 do_help = -1;
6686 }
6687 #ifdef USE_GTK
6688 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
6689 else if (last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6690 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6691 #endif
6692 goto OTHER;
6693
6694 case FocusOut:
6695 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6696 goto OTHER;
6697
6698 case MotionNotify:
6699 {
6700 last_user_time = event.xmotion.time;
6701 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6702 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6703
6704 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6705 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6706 f = last_mouse_frame;
6707 else
6708 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6709
6710 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6711 {
6712 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6713 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6714 }
6715
6716 #ifdef USE_GTK
6717 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6718 f = 0;
6719 #endif
6720 if (f)
6721 {
6722
6723 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed.
6724 Don't let popup menus influence things (bug#1261). */
6725 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window) && !popup_activated ())
6726 {
6727 Lisp_Object window;
6728
6729 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6730 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6731 0, 0);
6732
6733 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6734 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6735 will be selected only when it is active. */
6736 if (WINDOWP (window)
6737 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6738 && !EQ (window, selected_window)
6739 /* For click-to-focus window managers
6740 create event iff we don't leave the
6741 selected frame. */
6742 && (focus_follows_mouse
6743 || (EQ (XWINDOW (window)->frame,
6744 XWINDOW (selected_window)->frame))))
6745 {
6746 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6747 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
6748 }
6749
6750 last_window=window;
6751 }
6752 if (!note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion))
6753 help_echo_string = previous_help_echo_string;
6754 }
6755 else
6756 {
6757 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6758 struct scroll_bar *bar
6759 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6760 event.xmotion.window);
6761
6762 if (bar)
6763 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6764 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6765
6766 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6767 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6768 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6769 }
6770
6771 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6772 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6773 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6774 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6775 do_help = 1;
6776 goto OTHER;
6777 }
6778
6779 case ConfigureNotify:
6780 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6781 #ifdef USE_GTK
6782 if (!f
6783 && (f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window))
6784 && event.xconfigure.window == FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
6785 {
6786 xg_frame_resized (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6787 event.xconfigure.height);
6788 f = 0;
6789 }
6790 #endif
6791 if (f)
6792 {
6793 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6794 #ifndef USE_GTK
6795 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6796 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6797
6798 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6799 is called by the code that handles resizing
6800 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6801
6802 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6803 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6804 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6805 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6806 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6807 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6808 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6809 {
6810 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6811 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6812 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6813 }
6814
6815 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6816 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6817 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6818 #endif
6819
6820 #ifdef USE_GTK
6821 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6822 Only get real positions when mapped. */
6823 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6824 && gtk_widget_get_mapped (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6825 #endif
6826 {
6827 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6828 }
6829
6830 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6831 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6832 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6833 #endif
6834
6835 }
6836 goto OTHER;
6837
6838 case ButtonRelease:
6839 case ButtonPress:
6840 {
6841 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6842 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6843 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6844
6845 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6846 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
6847 last_user_time = event.xbutton.time;
6848
6849 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6850 && last_mouse_frame
6851 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6852 f = last_mouse_frame;
6853 else
6854 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6855
6856 #ifdef USE_GTK
6857 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6858 f = 0;
6859 #endif
6860 if (f)
6861 {
6862 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6863 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6864 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6865 {
6866 Lisp_Object window;
6867 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6868 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6869
6870 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 1);
6871 tool_bar_p = EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window);
6872
6873 if (tool_bar_p && event.xbutton.button < 4)
6874 {
6875 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y,
6876 event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress,
6877 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6878 event.xbutton.state));
6879 }
6880 }
6881
6882 if (!tool_bar_p)
6883 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6884 if (! popup_activated ())
6885 #endif
6886 {
6887 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
6888 {
6889 if (event.type == ButtonPress
6890 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
6891 {
6892 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6893 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6894 }
6895 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6896 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6897 }
6898 else
6899 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6900 }
6901 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
6902 xembed_send_message (f, event.xbutton.time,
6903 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
6904 }
6905 else
6906 {
6907 struct scroll_bar *bar
6908 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6909 event.xbutton.window);
6910
6911 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6912 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6913 scroll bars. */
6914 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6915 {
6916 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6917 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6918 }
6919 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6920 if (bar)
6921 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6922 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6923 }
6924
6925 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6926 {
6927 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6928 last_mouse_frame = f;
6929
6930 if (!tool_bar_p)
6931 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6932 }
6933 else
6934 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6935
6936 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
6937 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
6938 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
6939 if (f != 0)
6940 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6941
6942 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6943 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, &event);
6944 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6945 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6946 Instead, save it away
6947 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6948 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6949 if (! popup_activated ()
6950 #ifdef USE_GTK
6951 /* Gtk+ menus only react to the first three buttons. */
6952 && event.xbutton.button < 3
6953 #endif
6954 && f && event.type == ButtonPress
6955 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6956 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6957 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6958 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6959 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6960 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
6961 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
6962 {
6963 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6964 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
6965 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6966 }
6967 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6968 {
6969 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
6970 goto OTHER;
6971 }
6972 else
6973 goto OTHER;
6974 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6975 }
6976 break;
6977
6978 case CirculateNotify:
6979 goto OTHER;
6980
6981 case CirculateRequest:
6982 goto OTHER;
6983
6984 case VisibilityNotify:
6985 goto OTHER;
6986
6987 case MappingNotify:
6988 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
6989 local cache. */
6990 switch (event.xmapping.request)
6991 {
6992 case MappingModifier:
6993 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
6994 /* This is meant to fall through. */
6995 case MappingKeyboard:
6996 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
6997 }
6998 goto OTHER;
6999
7000 case DestroyNotify:
7001 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
7002 break;
7003
7004 default:
7005 OTHER:
7006 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7007 BLOCK_INPUT;
7008 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
7009 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
7010 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7011 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
7012 break;
7013 }
7014
7015 done:
7016 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
7017 {
7018 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
7019 count++;
7020 }
7021
7022 if (do_help
7023 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
7024 {
7025 Lisp_Object frame;
7026
7027 if (f)
7028 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
7029 else
7030 frame = Qnil;
7031
7032 if (do_help > 0)
7033 {
7034 any_help_event_p = 1;
7035 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
7036 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
7037 }
7038 else
7039 {
7040 help_echo_string = Qnil;
7041 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
7042 }
7043 count++;
7044 }
7045
7046 SAFE_FREE ();
7047 *eventptr = event;
7048 return count;
7049 }
7050
7051 #if defined USE_GTK || defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
7052
7053 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
7054 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
7055 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
7056
7057 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
7058 int
7059 x_dispatch_event (XEvent *event, Display *display)
7060 {
7061 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7062 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
7063
7064 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
7065
7066 if (dpyinfo)
7067 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
7068
7069 return finish;
7070 }
7071 #endif
7072
7073
7074 /* Read events coming from the X server.
7075 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler.
7076 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
7077
7078 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
7079 thus pretending to be `read' (except the characters we store
7080 in the keyboard buffer can be multibyte, so are not necessarily
7081 C chars).
7082
7083 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
7084
7085 static int
7086 XTread_socket (struct terminal *terminal, int expected, struct input_event *hold_quit)
7087 {
7088 int count = 0;
7089 int event_found = 0;
7090
7091 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
7092 {
7093 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
7094 #ifdef SYNC_INPUT
7095 pending_signals = 1;
7096 #endif
7097 return -1;
7098 }
7099
7100 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
7101 #ifdef SYNC_INPUT
7102 pending_signals = pending_atimers;
7103 #endif
7104 BLOCK_INPUT;
7105
7106 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
7107 input_signal_count++;
7108
7109 ++handling_signal;
7110
7111 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7112 if (terminal->display_info.x == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7113 {
7114 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7115 x_io_error_quitter (terminal->display_info.x->display);
7116 }
7117
7118 #ifndef USE_GTK
7119 while (XPending (terminal->display_info.x->display))
7120 {
7121 int finish;
7122 XEvent event;
7123
7124 XNextEvent (terminal->display_info.x->display, &event);
7125
7126 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7127 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7128 if (x_filter_event (terminal->display_info.x, &event))
7129 continue;
7130 #endif
7131 event_found = 1;
7132
7133 count += handle_one_xevent (terminal->display_info.x,
7134 &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7135
7136 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7137 goto out;
7138 }
7139
7140 out:;
7141
7142 #else /* USE_GTK */
7143
7144 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7145 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7146 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7147 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7148
7149 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7150 from all displays. */
7151
7152 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7153 {
7154 current_count = count;
7155 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7156
7157 gtk_main_iteration ();
7158
7159 count = current_count;
7160 current_count = -1;
7161 current_hold_quit = 0;
7162
7163 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7164 break;
7165 }
7166 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7167
7168 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7169 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7170 if (! event_found)
7171 {
7172 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7173 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7174 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7175 x_noop_count++;
7176 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7177 {
7178 x_noop_count=0;
7179
7180 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7181 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7182
7183 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7184
7185 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7186 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7187 }
7188 }
7189
7190 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7191 raise it now. */
7192 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7193 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7194 {
7195 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7196 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7197 }
7198
7199 --handling_signal;
7200 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7201
7202 return count;
7203 }
7204
7205
7206
7207 \f
7208 /***********************************************************************
7209 Text Cursor
7210 ***********************************************************************/
7211
7212 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7213 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7214
7215 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7216 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7217 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7218
7219 static void
7220 x_clip_to_row (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int area, GC gc)
7221 {
7222 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7223 XRectangle clip_rect;
7224 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7225
7226 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7227
7228 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7229 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
7230 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7231 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7232 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7233
7234 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7235 }
7236
7237
7238 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7239
7240 static void
7241 x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
7242 {
7243 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7244 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7245 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7246 int x, y, wd, h;
7247 XGCValues xgcv;
7248 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7249 GC gc;
7250
7251 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7252 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7253 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7254 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7255 return;
7256
7257 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7258 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &x, &y, &h);
7259 wd = w->phys_cursor_width;
7260
7261 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7262 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7263 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7264 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7265 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7266 else
7267 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7268 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7269 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7270
7271 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7272 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7273 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h - 1);
7274 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7275 }
7276
7277
7278 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7279
7280 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7281 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7282 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7283 --gerd. */
7284
7285 static void
7286 x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int width, enum text_cursor_kinds kind)
7287 {
7288 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7289 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7290
7291 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7292 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7293 and mini-buffer. */
7294 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7295 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7296 return;
7297
7298 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7299 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7300 the bar might not be in the window. */
7301 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7302 {
7303 struct glyph_row *r;
7304 r = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7305 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, r, DRAW_CURSOR);
7306 }
7307 else
7308 {
7309 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7310 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7311 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7312 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7313 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7314 XGCValues xgcv;
7315
7316 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7317 the bars cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7318 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7319 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7320 that the glyph is legible. */
7321 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7322 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7323 else
7324 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7325 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7326
7327 if (gc)
7328 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7329 else
7330 {
7331 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7332 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7333 }
7334
7335 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7336
7337 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7338 {
7339 int x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
7340
7341 if (width < 0)
7342 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7343 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7344
7345 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7346
7347 /* If the character under cursor is R2L, draw the bar cursor
7348 on the right of its glyph, rather than on the left. */
7349 if ((cursor_glyph->resolved_level & 1) != 0)
7350 x += cursor_glyph->pixel_width - width;
7351
7352 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc, x,
7353 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7354 width, row->height);
7355 }
7356 else
7357 {
7358 int dummy_x, dummy_y, dummy_h;
7359
7360 if (width < 0)
7361 width = row->height;
7362
7363 width = min (row->height, width);
7364
7365 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &dummy_x,
7366 &dummy_y, &dummy_h);
7367
7368 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7369 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7370 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7371 row->height - width),
7372 w->phys_cursor_width, width);
7373 }
7374
7375 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7376 }
7377 }
7378
7379
7380 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7381
7382 static void
7383 x_define_frame_cursor (struct frame *f, Cursor cursor)
7384 {
7385 if (!f->pointer_invisible
7386 && f->output_data.x->current_cursor != cursor)
7387 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7388 f->output_data.x->current_cursor = cursor;
7389 }
7390
7391
7392 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7393
7394 static void
7395 x_clear_frame_area (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height)
7396 {
7397 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7398 x, y, width, height, False);
7399 #ifdef USE_GTK
7400 /* Must queue a redraw, because scroll bars might have been cleared. */
7401 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
7402 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
7403 #endif
7404 }
7405
7406
7407 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7408
7409 static void
7410 x_draw_window_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *glyph_row, int x, int y, int cursor_type, int cursor_width, int on_p, int active_p)
7411 {
7412 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7413
7414 if (on_p)
7415 {
7416 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7417 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7418
7419 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7420 && (glyph_row->reversed_p
7421 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos < 0)
7422 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
7423 {
7424 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7425 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, glyph_row->reversed_p);
7426 }
7427 else
7428 {
7429 switch (cursor_type)
7430 {
7431 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7432 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7433 break;
7434
7435 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7436 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7437 break;
7438
7439 case BAR_CURSOR:
7440 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7441 break;
7442
7443 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7444 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7445 break;
7446
7447 case NO_CURSOR:
7448 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7449 break;
7450
7451 default:
7452 abort ();
7453 }
7454 }
7455
7456 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7457 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7458 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7459 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7460 #endif
7461 }
7462
7463 #ifndef XFlush
7464 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7465 #endif
7466 }
7467
7468 \f
7469 /* Icons. */
7470
7471 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7472
7473 int
7474 x_bitmap_icon (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object file)
7475 {
7476 ptrdiff_t bitmap_id;
7477
7478 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7479 return 1;
7480
7481 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7482 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7483 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7484 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7485
7486 if (STRINGP (file))
7487 {
7488 #ifdef USE_GTK
7489 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7490 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7491 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7492 return 0;
7493 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7494 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7495 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7496 }
7497 else
7498 {
7499 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7500 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7501 {
7502 ptrdiff_t rc = -1;
7503
7504 #ifdef USE_GTK
7505
7506 if (xg_set_icon (f, xg_default_icon_file)
7507 || xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits))
7508 return 0;
7509
7510 #elif defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
7511
7512 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits);
7513 if (rc != -1)
7514 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7515
7516 #endif
7517
7518 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
7519 if (rc == -1)
7520 {
7521 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, (char *) gnu_xbm_bits,
7522 gnu_xbm_width, gnu_xbm_height);
7523 if (rc == -1)
7524 return 1;
7525
7526 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7527 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7528 }
7529 }
7530
7531 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7532 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7533 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7534 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7535 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7536
7537 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7538 }
7539
7540 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7541 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7542
7543 return 0;
7544 }
7545
7546
7547 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7548 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7549
7550 int
7551 x_text_icon (struct frame *f, const char *icon_name)
7552 {
7553 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7554 return 1;
7555
7556 {
7557 XTextProperty text;
7558 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7559 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7560 text.format = 8;
7561 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7562 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7563 }
7564
7565 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7566 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7567 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7568 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7569
7570 return 0;
7571 }
7572 \f
7573 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7574
7575 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7576 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
7577
7578 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
7579 be called from a signal handler.
7580 */
7581
7582 struct x_error_message_stack {
7583 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7584 Display *dpy;
7585 struct x_error_message_stack *prev;
7586 };
7587 static struct x_error_message_stack *x_error_message;
7588
7589 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7590 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
7591 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7592
7593 static void
7594 x_error_catcher (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7595 {
7596 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code,
7597 x_error_message->string,
7598 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7599 }
7600
7601 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7602 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7603 operating on.
7604
7605 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7606 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7607 stored in *x_error_message.
7608
7609 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7610 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7611
7612 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7613
7614 void
7615 x_catch_errors (Display *dpy)
7616 {
7617 struct x_error_message_stack *data = xmalloc (sizeof (*data));
7618
7619 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7620 XSync (dpy, False);
7621
7622 data->dpy = dpy;
7623 data->string[0] = 0;
7624 data->prev = x_error_message;
7625 x_error_message = data;
7626 }
7627
7628 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
7629 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
7630
7631 void
7632 x_uncatch_errors (void)
7633 {
7634 struct x_error_message_stack *tmp;
7635
7636 BLOCK_INPUT;
7637
7638 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7639 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7640 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message->dpy) != 0)
7641 XSync (x_error_message->dpy, False);
7642
7643 tmp = x_error_message;
7644 x_error_message = x_error_message->prev;
7645 xfree (tmp);
7646 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7647 }
7648
7649 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7650 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7651 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7652
7653 void
7654 x_check_errors (Display *dpy, const char *format)
7655 {
7656 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7657 XSync (dpy, False);
7658
7659 if (x_error_message->string[0])
7660 {
7661 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7662 memcpy (string, x_error_message->string, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7663 x_uncatch_errors ();
7664 error (format, string);
7665 }
7666 }
7667
7668 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7669 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7670
7671 int
7672 x_had_errors_p (Display *dpy)
7673 {
7674 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7675 XSync (dpy, False);
7676
7677 return x_error_message->string[0] != 0;
7678 }
7679
7680 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7681
7682 void
7683 x_clear_errors (Display *dpy)
7684 {
7685 x_error_message->string[0] = 0;
7686 }
7687
7688 #if 0 /* See comment in unwind_to_catch why calling this is a bad
7689 * idea. --lorentey */
7690 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
7691
7692 void
7693 x_fully_uncatch_errors (void)
7694 {
7695 while (x_error_message)
7696 x_uncatch_errors ();
7697 }
7698 #endif
7699
7700 #if 0
7701 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7702 x_trace_wire (void)
7703 {
7704 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7705 }
7706 #endif /* ! 0 */
7707
7708 \f
7709 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
7710 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
7711 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
7712 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
7713 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
7714
7715 static void
7716 x_connection_signal (int signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
7717 /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
7718 {
7719 #ifdef USG
7720 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
7721 must reestablish each time */
7722 signal (signalnum, x_connection_signal);
7723 #endif /* USG */
7724 }
7725
7726 \f
7727 /************************************************************************
7728 Handling X errors
7729 ************************************************************************/
7730
7731 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7732
7733 static char *error_msg;
7734
7735 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7736 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7737
7738 static void
7739 x_connection_closed (Display *dpy, const char *error_message)
7740 {
7741 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7742 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7743 ptrdiff_t idx = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7744
7745 error_msg = (char *) alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7746 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7747 handling_signal = 0;
7748
7749 /* Inhibit redisplay while frames are being deleted. */
7750 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay, Qt);
7751
7752 if (dpyinfo)
7753 {
7754 /* Protect display from being closed when we delete the last
7755 frame on it. */
7756 dpyinfo->reference_count++;
7757 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count++;
7758 }
7759
7760 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7761 that are on the dead display. */
7762 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7763 {
7764 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7765 minibuf_frame
7766 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7767 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7768 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7769 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7770 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7771 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7772 }
7773
7774 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7775 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7776 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7777 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7778 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7779 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7780 {
7781 /* Set this to t so that delete_frame won't get confused
7782 trying to find a replacement. */
7783 KVAR (FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame)), Vdefault_minibuffer_frame) = Qt;
7784 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7785 }
7786
7787 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display in the
7788 first place, so don't try to close it. */
7789 if (dpyinfo)
7790 {
7791 /* We can not call XtCloseDisplay here because it calls XSync.
7792 XSync inside the error handler apparently hangs Emacs. On
7793 current Xt versions, this isn't needed either. */
7794 #ifdef USE_GTK
7795 /* A long-standing GTK bug prevents proper disconnect handling
7796 (https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715). Once,
7797 the resulting Glib error message loop filled a user's disk.
7798 To avoid this, kill Emacs unconditionally on disconnect. */
7799 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
7800 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n\
7801 When compiled with GTK, Emacs cannot recover from X disconnects.\n\
7802 This is a GTK bug: https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715\n\
7803 For details, see etc/PROBLEMS.\n",
7804 error_msg);
7805 abort ();
7806 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7807
7808 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7809 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7810
7811 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
7812 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count--;
7813 if (dpyinfo->reference_count != 0)
7814 /* We have just closed all frames on this display. */
7815 abort ();
7816
7817 {
7818 Lisp_Object tmp;
7819 XSETTERMINAL (tmp, dpyinfo->terminal);
7820 Fdelete_terminal (tmp, Qnoelisp);
7821 }
7822 }
7823
7824 if (terminal_list == 0)
7825 {
7826 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7827 Fkill_emacs (make_number (70));
7828 /* NOTREACHED */
7829 }
7830
7831 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
7832 #ifdef SIGIO
7833 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO));
7834 #endif
7835 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM));
7836 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7837
7838 unbind_to (idx, Qnil);
7839 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7840
7841 /* Tell GCC not to suggest attribute 'noreturn' for this function. */
7842 IF_LINT (if (! terminal_list) return; )
7843
7844 /* Here, we absolutely have to use a non-local exit (e.g. signal, throw,
7845 longjmp), because returning from this function would get us back into
7846 Xlib's code which will directly call `exit'. */
7847 error ("%s", error_msg);
7848 }
7849
7850 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
7851 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
7852 static void x_error_quitter (Display *, XErrorEvent *);
7853
7854 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7855 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7856
7857 static int
7858 x_error_handler (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7859 {
7860 if (x_error_message)
7861 x_error_catcher (display, event);
7862 else
7863 x_error_quitter (display, event);
7864 return 0;
7865 }
7866
7867 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7868 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7869 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7870
7871 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
7872
7873 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
7874 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
7875
7876 static void NO_INLINE
7877 x_error_quitter (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7878 {
7879 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7880
7881 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
7882 or colors that are not defined. */
7883
7884 if (event->error_code == BadName)
7885 return;
7886
7887 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7888 original error handler. */
7889
7890 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7891 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7892 buf, event->request_code);
7893 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7894 }
7895
7896
7897 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7898 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7899 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7900
7901 static int
7902 x_io_error_quitter (Display *display)
7903 {
7904 char buf[256];
7905
7906 snprintf (buf, sizeof buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'",
7907 DisplayString (display));
7908 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7909 return 0;
7910 }
7911 \f
7912 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7913
7914 /* Give frame F the font FONT-OBJECT as its default font. The return
7915 value is FONT-OBJECT. FONTSET is an ID of the fontset for the
7916 frame. If it is negative, generate a new fontset from
7917 FONT-OBJECT. */
7918
7919 Lisp_Object
7920 x_new_font (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object font_object, int fontset)
7921 {
7922 struct font *font = XFONT_OBJECT (font_object);
7923
7924 if (fontset < 0)
7925 fontset = fontset_from_font (font_object);
7926 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7927 if (FRAME_FONT (f) == font)
7928 /* This font is already set in frame F. There's nothing more to
7929 do. */
7930 return font_object;
7931
7932 FRAME_FONT (f) = font;
7933 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = font->baseline_offset;
7934 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = font->average_width;
7935 FRAME_SPACE_WIDTH (f) = font->space_width;
7936 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
7937
7938 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7939
7940 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7941 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
7942 {
7943 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7944 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
7945 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
7946 }
7947 else
7948 {
7949 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7950 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
7951 }
7952
7953 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
7954 {
7955 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7956 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7957 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7958 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
7959 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
7960 }
7961
7962 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7963 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
7964 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
7965 {
7966 BLOCK_INPUT;
7967 xic_set_xfontset (f, SSDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
7968 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7969 }
7970 #endif
7971
7972 return font_object;
7973 }
7974
7975 \f
7976 /***********************************************************************
7977 X Input Methods
7978 ***********************************************************************/
7979
7980 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7981
7982 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7983
7984 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
7985 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
7986 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
7987
7988 static void
7989 xim_destroy_callback (XIM xim, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
7990 {
7991 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
7992 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7993
7994 BLOCK_INPUT;
7995
7996 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
7997 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7998 {
7999 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8000 if (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
8001 {
8002 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
8003 xic_free_xfontset (f);
8004 }
8005 }
8006
8007 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
8008 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8009 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8010 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8011 }
8012
8013 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
8014
8015 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8016 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
8017 extern char *XSetIMValues (XIM, ...);
8018 #endif
8019
8020 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8021 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
8022
8023 static void
8024 xim_open_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8025 {
8026 XIM xim;
8027
8028 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8029 if (use_xim)
8030 {
8031 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8032 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8033 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
8034 emacs_class);
8035 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
8036
8037 if (xim)
8038 {
8039 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8040 XIMCallback destroy;
8041 #endif
8042
8043 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
8044 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
8045
8046 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8047 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
8048 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
8049 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
8050 #endif
8051 }
8052 }
8053
8054 else
8055 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8056 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8057 }
8058
8059
8060 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8061
8062 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8063 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8064 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8065 when the callback was registered. */
8066
8067 static void
8068 xim_instantiate_callback (Display *display, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
8069 {
8070 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8071 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8072
8073 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8074 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8075 return;
8076
8077 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8078
8079 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8080 as they have no XIC. */
8081 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8082 {
8083 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8084
8085 BLOCK_INPUT;
8086 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8087 {
8088 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8089
8090 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
8091 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8092 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8093 {
8094 create_frame_xic (f);
8095 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8096 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8097 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8098 {
8099 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8100 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8101 }
8102 }
8103 }
8104
8105 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8106 }
8107 }
8108
8109 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8110
8111
8112 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8113 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8114 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8115 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8116
8117 static void
8118 xim_initialize (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8119 {
8120 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8121 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8122 if (use_xim)
8123 {
8124 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8125 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst;
8126 ptrdiff_t len;
8127
8128 xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct xim_inst_t));
8129 dpyinfo->xim_callback_data = xim_inst;
8130 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8131 len = strlen (resource_name);
8132 xim_inst->resource_name = (char *) xmalloc (len + 1);
8133 memcpy (xim_inst->resource_name, resource_name, len + 1);
8134 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8135 resource_name, emacs_class,
8136 xim_instantiate_callback,
8137 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8138 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8139 least, hence the configure test. */
8140 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8141 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8142 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8143 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8144 }
8145 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8146 }
8147
8148
8149 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8150
8151 static void
8152 xim_close_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
8153 {
8154 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8155 if (use_xim)
8156 {
8157 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8158 if (dpyinfo->display)
8159 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8160 NULL, emacs_class,
8161 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8162 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data->resource_name);
8163 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data);
8164 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8165 if (dpyinfo->display)
8166 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8167 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8168 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8169 }
8170 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8171 }
8172
8173 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8174
8175
8176 \f
8177 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8178 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8179
8180 static void
8181 x_calc_absolute_position (struct frame *f)
8182 {
8183 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8184
8185 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8186 is already for the top-left corner. */
8187 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8188 return;
8189
8190 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8191 position that fits on the screen. */
8192 if (flags & XNegative)
8193 f->left_pos = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8194 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos;
8195
8196 {
8197 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8198
8199 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8200 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8201 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8202
8203 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8204 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8205 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8206 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8207 is right, though.
8208
8209 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8210 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8211
8212 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8213 #endif
8214
8215 if (flags & YNegative)
8216 f->top_pos = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8217 - height + f->top_pos;
8218 }
8219
8220 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8221 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8222 so the flags should correspond. */
8223 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8224 }
8225
8226 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8227 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8228 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8229 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8230 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8231
8232 void
8233 x_set_offset (struct frame *f, register int xoff, register int yoff, int change_gravity)
8234 {
8235 int modified_top, modified_left;
8236
8237 if (change_gravity > 0)
8238 {
8239 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->left_before_move = f->left_pos;
8240 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->top_before_move = f->top_pos;
8241
8242 f->top_pos = yoff;
8243 f->left_pos = xoff;
8244 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8245 if (xoff < 0)
8246 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8247 if (yoff < 0)
8248 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8249 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8250 }
8251 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8252
8253 BLOCK_INPUT;
8254 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8255
8256 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8257 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8258
8259 if (change_gravity != 0 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8260 {
8261 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8262 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8263 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8264 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8265 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8266 }
8267
8268 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8269 modified_left, modified_top);
8270
8271 x_sync_with_move (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos,
8272 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8273 ? 1 : 0);
8274
8275 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
8276 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
8277 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
8278 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
8279 of the frame.
8280
8281 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
8282 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
8283 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
8284
8285 if (change_gravity != 0 &&
8286 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8287 || (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A
8288 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left == 0
8289 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top == 0))))
8290 x_check_expected_move (f, modified_left, modified_top);
8291
8292 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8293 }
8294
8295 /* Return non-zero if _NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK window exists and _NET_SUPPORTED
8296 on the root window for frame F contains ATOMNAME.
8297 This is how a WM check shall be done according to the Window Manager
8298 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8299 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec. */
8300
8301 static int
8302 wm_supports (struct frame *f, Atom want_atom)
8303 {
8304 Atom actual_type;
8305 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8306 int i, rc, actual_format;
8307 Window wmcheck_window;
8308 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8309 Window target_window = dpyinfo->root_window;
8310 long max_len = 65536;
8311 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8312 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8313 Atom target_type = XA_WINDOW;
8314
8315 BLOCK_INPUT;
8316
8317 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8318 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8319 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check,
8320 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8321 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8322 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8323
8324 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_WINDOW || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8325 {
8326 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8327 x_uncatch_errors ();
8328 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8329 return 0;
8330 }
8331
8332 wmcheck_window = *(Window *) tmp_data;
8333 XFree (tmp_data);
8334
8335 /* Check if window exists. */
8336 XSelectInput (dpy, wmcheck_window, StructureNotifyMask);
8337 x_sync (f);
8338 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8339 {
8340 x_uncatch_errors ();
8341 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8342 return 0;
8343 }
8344
8345 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_window != wmcheck_window)
8346 {
8347 /* Window changed, reload atoms */
8348 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms != NULL)
8349 XFree (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms);
8350 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
8351 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
8352 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
8353
8354 target_type = XA_ATOM;
8355 tmp_data = NULL;
8356 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8357 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported,
8358 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8359 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8360 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8361
8362 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_ATOM || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8363 {
8364 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8365 x_uncatch_errors ();
8366 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8367 return 0;
8368 }
8369
8370 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = (Atom *)tmp_data;
8371 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = actual_size;
8372 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = wmcheck_window;
8373 }
8374
8375 rc = 0;
8376
8377 for (i = 0; rc == 0 && i < dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms; ++i)
8378 rc = dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms[i] == want_atom;
8379
8380 x_uncatch_errors ();
8381 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8382
8383 return rc;
8384 }
8385
8386 static void
8387 set_wm_state (Lisp_Object frame, int add, Atom atom, Atom value)
8388 {
8389 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame));
8390
8391 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8392 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8393 make_number (32),
8394 /* 1 = add, 0 = remove */
8395 Fcons
8396 (make_number (add ? 1 : 0),
8397 Fcons
8398 (make_fixnum_or_float (atom),
8399 value != 0
8400 ? Fcons (make_fixnum_or_float (value), Qnil)
8401 : Qnil)));
8402 }
8403
8404 void
8405 x_set_sticky (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object new_value, Lisp_Object old_value)
8406 {
8407 Lisp_Object frame;
8408 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8409
8410 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8411
8412 set_wm_state (frame, NILP (new_value) ? 0 : 1,
8413 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky, None);
8414 }
8415
8416 /* Return the current _NET_WM_STATE.
8417 SIZE_STATE is set to one of the FULLSCREEN_* values.
8418 STICKY is set to 1 if the sticky state is set, 0 if not. */
8419
8420 static void
8421 get_current_wm_state (struct frame *f,
8422 Window window,
8423 int *size_state,
8424 int *sticky)
8425 {
8426 Atom actual_type;
8427 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8428 int i, rc, actual_format;
8429 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8430 long max_len = 65536;
8431 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8432 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8433 Atom target_type = XA_ATOM;
8434
8435 *sticky = 0;
8436 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8437
8438 BLOCK_INPUT;
8439 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8440 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, window, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8441 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8442 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8443 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8444
8445 if (rc != Success || actual_type != target_type || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8446 {
8447 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8448 x_uncatch_errors ();
8449 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8450 return;
8451 }
8452
8453 x_uncatch_errors ();
8454
8455 for (i = 0; i < actual_size; ++i)
8456 {
8457 Atom a = ((Atom*)tmp_data)[i];
8458 if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz)
8459 {
8460 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8461 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8462 else
8463 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_WIDTH;
8464 }
8465 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert)
8466 {
8467 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH)
8468 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8469 else
8470 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT;
8471 }
8472 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen)
8473 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_BOTH;
8474 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky)
8475 *sticky = 1;
8476 }
8477
8478 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8479 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8480 }
8481
8482 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
8483
8484 static int
8485 do_ewmh_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8486 {
8487 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8488 int have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state);
8489 int cur, dummy;
8490
8491 get_current_wm_state (f, FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &cur, &dummy);
8492
8493 /* Some window managers don't say they support _NET_WM_STATE, but they do say
8494 they support _NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN. Try that also. */
8495 if (!have_net_atom)
8496 have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen);
8497
8498 if (have_net_atom && cur != f->want_fullscreen)
8499 {
8500 Lisp_Object frame;
8501
8502 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8503
8504 /* Keep number of calls to set_wm_state as low as possible.
8505 Some window managers, or possible Gtk+, hangs when too many
8506 are sent at once. */
8507 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8508 {
8509 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8510 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
8511 || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8512 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8513 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8514 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8515 break;
8516 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8517 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
8518 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8519 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8520 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8521 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8522 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz, None);
8523 break;
8524 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8525 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
8526 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8527 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8528 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz);
8529 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8530 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert, None);
8531 break;
8532 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8533 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8534 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8535 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8536 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8537 break;
8538 case FULLSCREEN_NONE:
8539 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8540 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8541 else
8542 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8543 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8544 }
8545
8546 f->want_fullscreen = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8547
8548 }
8549
8550 return have_net_atom;
8551 }
8552
8553 static void
8554 XTfullscreen_hook (FRAME_PTR f)
8555 {
8556 if (f->async_visible)
8557 {
8558 BLOCK_INPUT;
8559 x_check_fullscreen (f);
8560 x_sync (f);
8561 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8562 }
8563 }
8564
8565
8566 static void
8567 x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *f, XPropertyEvent *event)
8568 {
8569 int value = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8570 Lisp_Object lval;
8571 int sticky = 0;
8572
8573 get_current_wm_state (f, event->window, &value, &sticky);
8574 lval = Qnil;
8575 switch (value)
8576 {
8577 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8578 lval = Qfullwidth;
8579 break;
8580 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8581 lval = Qfullheight;
8582 break;
8583 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8584 lval = Qfullboth;
8585 break;
8586 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8587 lval = Qmaximized;
8588 break;
8589 }
8590
8591 store_frame_param (f, Qfullscreen, lval);
8592 store_frame_param (f, Qsticky, sticky ? Qt : Qnil);
8593 }
8594
8595 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8596 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8597 static void
8598 x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8599 {
8600 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f))
8601 return;
8602
8603 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
8604 return; /* Only fullscreen without WM or with EWM hints (above). */
8605
8606 /* Setting fullscreen to nil doesn't do anything. We could save the
8607 last non-fullscreen size and restore it, but it seems like a
8608 lot of work for this unusual case (no window manager running). */
8609
8610 if (f->want_fullscreen != FULLSCREEN_NONE)
8611 {
8612 int width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f), height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8613 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8614
8615 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8616 {
8617 /* No difference between these two when there is no WM */
8618 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8619 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8620 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8621 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8622 break;
8623 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8624 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8625 break;
8626 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8627 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8628 }
8629
8630 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8631 width, height);
8632 }
8633 }
8634
8635 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
8636 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
8637 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
8638 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
8639 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
8640 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
8641 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
8642
8643 static void
8644 x_check_expected_move (struct frame *f, int expected_left, int expected_top)
8645 {
8646 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8647
8648 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
8649 window manager window around the frame. */
8650
8651 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8652
8653 if (current_left != expected_left || current_top != expected_top)
8654 {
8655 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
8656
8657 int adjusted_left;
8658 int adjusted_top;
8659
8660 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8661 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expected_left - current_left;
8662 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expected_top - current_top;
8663
8664 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
8665
8666 adjusted_left = expected_left + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8667 adjusted_top = expected_top + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8668
8669 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8670 adjusted_left, adjusted_top);
8671
8672 x_sync_with_move (f, expected_left, expected_top, 0);
8673 }
8674 else
8675 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
8676 frame's position. */
8677
8678 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8679 }
8680
8681
8682 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
8683 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
8684 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
8685 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
8686 of an exact comparison. */
8687
8688 static void
8689 x_sync_with_move (struct frame *f, int left, int top, int fuzzy)
8690 {
8691 int count = 0;
8692
8693 while (count++ < 50)
8694 {
8695 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8696
8697 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
8698 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
8699 loop. */
8700
8701 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8702 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8703
8704 if (fuzzy)
8705 {
8706 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
8707 pixels. */
8708
8709 if (eabs (current_left - left) <= 10
8710 && eabs (current_top - top) <= 40)
8711 return;
8712 }
8713 else if (current_left == left && current_top == top)
8714 return;
8715 }
8716
8717 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
8718 will then return up-to-date position info. */
8719
8720 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000, 0, 0, Qnil, NULL, 0);
8721 }
8722
8723
8724 /* Wait for an event on frame F matching EVENTTYPE. */
8725 void
8726 x_wait_for_event (struct frame *f, int eventtype)
8727 {
8728 int level = interrupt_input_blocked;
8729
8730 SELECT_TYPE fds;
8731 EMACS_TIME tmo, tmo_at, time_now;
8732 int fd = ConnectionNumber (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8733
8734 pending_event_wait.f = f;
8735 pending_event_wait.eventtype = eventtype;
8736
8737 /* Set timeout to 0.1 second. Hopefully not noticable.
8738 Maybe it should be configurable. */
8739 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (tmo, 0, 100000);
8740 EMACS_GET_TIME (tmo_at);
8741 EMACS_ADD_TIME (tmo_at, tmo_at, tmo);
8742
8743 while (pending_event_wait.eventtype)
8744 {
8745 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
8746 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8747 /* XTread_socket is called after unblock. */
8748 BLOCK_INPUT;
8749 interrupt_input_blocked = level;
8750
8751 FD_ZERO (&fds);
8752 FD_SET (fd, &fds);
8753
8754 EMACS_GET_TIME (time_now);
8755 EMACS_SUB_TIME (tmo, tmo_at, time_now);
8756
8757 if (EMACS_TIME_NEG_P (tmo) || select (fd+1, &fds, NULL, NULL, &tmo) == 0)
8758 break; /* Timeout */
8759 }
8760 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
8761 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
8762 }
8763
8764
8765 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8766 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8767 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8768 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8769
8770 static void
8771 x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8772 {
8773 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8774
8775 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8776 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8777 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8778 ? 0
8779 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
8780
8781 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8782
8783 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols)
8784 + FRAME_TOOLBAR_WIDTH (f);
8785 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows)
8786 + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8787
8788 if (change_gravity) f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8789 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8790 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8791 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8792
8793
8794 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8795 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8796 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8797 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8798 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8799
8800 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8801 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8802 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8803 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8804
8805 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8806 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8807 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8808 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8809 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8810
8811 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8812 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8813
8814 /* But the ConfigureNotify may in fact never arrive, and then this is
8815 not right if the frame is visible. Instead wait (with timeout)
8816 for the ConfigureNotify. */
8817 if (f->async_visible)
8818 x_wait_for_event (f, ConfigureNotify);
8819 else
8820 {
8821 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8822 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8823 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8824 x_sync (f);
8825 }
8826 }
8827
8828
8829 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8830 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8831 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8832 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8833
8834 void
8835 x_set_window_size (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8836 {
8837 BLOCK_INPUT;
8838
8839 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
8840 {
8841 int r, c;
8842
8843 /* When the frame is maximized/fullscreen or running under for
8844 example Xmonad, x_set_window_size_1 will be a no-op.
8845 In that case, the right thing to do is extend rows/cols to
8846 the current frame size. We do that first if x_set_window_size_1
8847 turns out to not be a no-op (there is no way to know).
8848 The size will be adjusted again if the frame gets a
8849 ConfigureNotify event as a result of x_set_window_size. */
8850 int pixelh = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8851 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8852 /* The menu bar is not part of text lines. The tool bar
8853 is however. */
8854 pixelh -= FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8855 #endif
8856 r = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, pixelh);
8857 /* Update f->scroll_bar_actual_width because it is used in
8858 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS. */
8859 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8860 = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8861 c = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f));
8862 change_frame_size (f, r, c, 0, 1, 0);
8863 }
8864
8865 #ifdef USE_GTK
8866 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8867 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8868 else
8869 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8870 #else /* not USE_GTK */
8871
8872 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8873
8874 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8875
8876 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8877 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8878
8879 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8880 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8881 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8882 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8883 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8884
8885 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8886 }
8887 \f
8888 /* Mouse warping. */
8889
8890 void
8891 x_set_mouse_position (struct frame *f, int x, int y)
8892 {
8893 int pix_x, pix_y;
8894
8895 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8896 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8897
8898 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8899 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8900
8901 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8902 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8903
8904 BLOCK_INPUT;
8905
8906 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8907 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8908 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8909 }
8910
8911 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8912
8913 void
8914 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (struct frame *f, int pix_x, int pix_y)
8915 {
8916 BLOCK_INPUT;
8917
8918 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8919 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8920 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8921 }
8922 \f
8923 /* Raise frame F. */
8924
8925 void
8926 x_raise_frame (struct frame *f)
8927 {
8928 BLOCK_INPUT;
8929 if (f->async_visible)
8930 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8931
8932 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8933 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8934 }
8935
8936 /* Lower frame F. */
8937
8938 static void
8939 x_lower_frame (struct frame *f)
8940 {
8941 if (f->async_visible)
8942 {
8943 BLOCK_INPUT;
8944 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8945 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8946 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8947 }
8948 }
8949
8950 /* Activate frame with Extended Window Manager Hints */
8951
8952 void
8953 x_ewmh_activate_frame (FRAME_PTR f)
8954 {
8955 /* See Window Manager Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8956 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec */
8957
8958 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8959 if (f->async_visible && wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window))
8960 {
8961 Lisp_Object frame;
8962 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8963 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8964 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window,
8965 make_number (32),
8966 Fcons (make_number (1),
8967 Fcons (make_number (last_user_time),
8968 Qnil)));
8969 }
8970 }
8971
8972 static void
8973 XTframe_raise_lower (FRAME_PTR f, int raise_flag)
8974 {
8975 if (raise_flag)
8976 x_raise_frame (f);
8977 else
8978 x_lower_frame (f);
8979 }
8980 \f
8981 /* XEmbed implementation. */
8982
8983 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK
8984
8985 /* XEmbed implementation. */
8986
8987 #define XEMBED_VERSION 0
8988
8989 static void
8990 xembed_set_info (struct frame *f, enum xembed_info flags)
8991 {
8992 unsigned long data[2];
8993 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8994
8995 data[0] = XEMBED_VERSION;
8996 data[1] = flags;
8997
8998 XChangeProperty (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8999 dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO, dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO,
9000 32, PropModeReplace, (unsigned char *) data, 2);
9001 }
9002 #endif /* defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK */
9003
9004 static void
9005 xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time t, enum xembed_message msg,
9006 long int detail, long int data1, long int data2)
9007 {
9008 XEvent event;
9009
9010 event.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9011 event.xclient.window = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc;
9012 event.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_XEMBED;
9013 event.xclient.format = 32;
9014 event.xclient.data.l[0] = t;
9015 event.xclient.data.l[1] = msg;
9016 event.xclient.data.l[2] = detail;
9017 event.xclient.data.l[3] = data1;
9018 event.xclient.data.l[4] = data2;
9019
9020 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc,
9021 False, NoEventMask, &event);
9022 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
9023 }
9024 \f
9025 /* Change of visibility. */
9026
9027 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
9028 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
9029 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
9030 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
9031 but it will become visible later when the window manager
9032 finishes with it. */
9033
9034 void
9035 x_make_frame_visible (struct frame *f)
9036 {
9037 Lisp_Object type;
9038 int original_top, original_left;
9039 int retry_count = 2;
9040
9041 retry:
9042
9043 BLOCK_INPUT;
9044
9045 type = x_icon_type (f);
9046 if (!NILP (type))
9047 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9048
9049 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9050 {
9051 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
9052 call x_set_offset a second time
9053 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
9054 before the window gets really visible. */
9055 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9056 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9057 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
9058 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9059
9060 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
9061
9062 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9063 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
9064 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9065 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9066 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9067 else
9068 {
9069 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9070 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9071 }
9072 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9073 #ifdef USE_GTK
9074 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9075 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9076 #else
9077 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9078 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9079 else
9080 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9081 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9082 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9083 }
9084
9085 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9086
9087 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
9088 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
9089 so that incoming events are handled. */
9090 {
9091 Lisp_Object frame;
9092 int count;
9093 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
9094 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
9095 will set it when they are handled. */
9096 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
9097
9098 original_left = f->left_pos;
9099 original_top = f->top_pos;
9100
9101 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
9102 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9103
9104 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
9105
9106 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
9107 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
9108 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
9109 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
9110
9111 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
9112 because the window manager may choose the position
9113 and we don't want to override it. */
9114
9115 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9116 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9117 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9118 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
9119 && previously_visible)
9120 {
9121 Drawable rootw;
9122 int x, y;
9123 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
9124
9125 BLOCK_INPUT;
9126
9127 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
9128 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
9129 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
9130 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
9131 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
9132 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
9133 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
9134 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9135 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
9136
9137 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
9138 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9139 original_left, original_top);
9140
9141 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9142 }
9143
9144 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9145
9146 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
9147 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
9148 MapNotify at all.. */
9149 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
9150 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
9151 {
9152 /* Force processing of queued events. */
9153 x_sync (f);
9154
9155 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
9156 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
9157 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
9158 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
9159 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
9160 probably a bug. */
9161 if (input_polling_used ())
9162 {
9163 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
9164 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
9165 handler reset it. */
9166 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
9167 poll_suppress_count = 1;
9168 poll_for_input_1 ();
9169 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
9170 }
9171
9172 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
9173 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9174 }
9175
9176 /* 2000-09-28: In
9177
9178 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
9179 (iconify-frame f)
9180 (raise-frame f))
9181
9182 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
9183 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
9184 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
9185 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
9186
9187 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count != 0)
9188 goto retry;
9189 }
9190 }
9191
9192 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
9193
9194 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
9195
9196 void
9197 x_make_frame_invisible (struct frame *f)
9198 {
9199 Window window;
9200
9201 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
9202 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9203
9204 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9205 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9206 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9207
9208 BLOCK_INPUT;
9209
9210 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
9211 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
9212 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
9213 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
9214 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
9215 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
9216
9217 #ifdef USE_GTK
9218 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9219 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9220 else
9221 #else
9222 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9223 xembed_set_info (f, 0);
9224 else
9225 #endif
9226 {
9227
9228 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
9229 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
9230 {
9231 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9232 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
9233 }
9234 }
9235
9236 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9237 just by the event that we get from the server.
9238 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9239 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9240 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9241 f->visible = 0;
9242 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
9243 f->async_visible = 0;
9244 f->async_iconified = 0;
9245
9246 x_sync (f);
9247
9248 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9249 }
9250
9251 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9252
9253 void
9254 x_iconify_frame (struct frame *f)
9255 {
9256 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9257 int result;
9258 #endif
9259 Lisp_Object type;
9260
9261 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9262 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9263 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9264
9265 if (f->async_iconified)
9266 return;
9267
9268 BLOCK_INPUT;
9269
9270 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9271
9272 type = x_icon_type (f);
9273 if (!NILP (type))
9274 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9275
9276 #ifdef USE_GTK
9277 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9278 {
9279 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9280 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9281
9282 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9283 f->iconified = 1;
9284 f->visible = 1;
9285 f->async_iconified = 1;
9286 f->async_visible = 0;
9287 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9288 return;
9289 }
9290 #endif
9291
9292 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9293
9294 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9295 {
9296 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9297 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9298 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9299 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9300 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
9301 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
9302 so we have to record it here. */
9303 f->iconified = 1;
9304 f->visible = 1;
9305 f->async_iconified = 1;
9306 f->async_visible = 0;
9307 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9308 return;
9309 }
9310
9311 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9312 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
9313 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
9314 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9315
9316 if (!result)
9317 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9318
9319 f->async_iconified = 1;
9320 f->async_visible = 0;
9321
9322
9323 BLOCK_INPUT;
9324 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9325 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9326 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9327
9328 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
9329 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
9330 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9331 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9332 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9333 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9334
9335 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
9336 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
9337
9338 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
9339 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
9340 {
9341 XEvent msg;
9342
9343 msg.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9344 msg.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9345 msg.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
9346 msg.xclient.format = 32;
9347 msg.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
9348
9349 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9350 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
9351 False,
9352 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
9353 &msg))
9354 {
9355 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9356 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9357 }
9358 }
9359
9360 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
9361 IconicState. */
9362 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9363
9364 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9365 {
9366 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
9367 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9368 }
9369
9370 f->async_iconified = 1;
9371 f->async_visible = 0;
9372
9373 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9374 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9375 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9376 }
9377
9378 \f
9379 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
9380
9381 void
9382 x_free_frame_resources (struct frame *f)
9383 {
9384 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9385 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
9386 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9387 Lisp_Object bar;
9388 struct scroll_bar *b;
9389 #endif
9390
9391 BLOCK_INPUT;
9392
9393 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9394 commands to the X server. */
9395 if (dpyinfo->display)
9396 {
9397 /* We must free faces before destroying windows because some
9398 font-driver (e.g. xft) access a window while finishing a
9399 face. */
9400 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9401 free_frame_faces (f);
9402
9403 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
9404 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
9405
9406 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9407 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
9408 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
9409 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
9410 toolkit scroll bars. */
9411 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
9412 {
9413 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
9414 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
9415 }
9416 #endif
9417
9418 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9419 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
9420 free_frame_xic (f);
9421 #endif
9422
9423 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9424 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9425 {
9426 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9427 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
9428 }
9429 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
9430 we are using a toolkit. */
9431 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9432 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9433
9434 free_frame_menubar (f);
9435 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9436
9437 #ifdef USE_GTK
9438 xg_free_frame_widgets (f);
9439 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9440
9441 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9442 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9443 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9444
9445 unload_color (f, FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9446 unload_color (f, FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9447 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
9448 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
9449 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
9450 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
9451
9452 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
9453 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
9454 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9455 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
9456 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9457 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9458 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
9459 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
9460 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
9461 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
9462 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9463 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
9464 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9465 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9466 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9467
9468 x_free_gcs (f);
9469 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9470 }
9471
9472 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9473 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9474 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9475
9476 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9477 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9478 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9479 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9480 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9481 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9482
9483 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9484 {
9485 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9486 = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9487 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9488 = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9489 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9490 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
9491 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9492 }
9493
9494 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9495 }
9496
9497
9498 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9499
9500 static void
9501 x_destroy_window (struct frame *f)
9502 {
9503 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9504
9505 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9506 commands to the X server. */
9507 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9508 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9509
9510 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9511 }
9512
9513 \f
9514 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9515
9516 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9517 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9518 that the window now has.
9519 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9520 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9521 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
9522
9523 #ifndef USE_GTK
9524 void
9525 x_wm_set_size_hint (struct frame *f, long flags, int user_position)
9526 {
9527 XSizeHints size_hints;
9528 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9529
9530 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9531 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9532
9533 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9534 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9535
9536 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9537 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9538
9539 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9540 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9541 size_hints.max_width = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9542 - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9543 size_hints.max_height = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9544 - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9545
9546 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes. */
9547 {
9548 int base_width, base_height;
9549 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9550
9551 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9552 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9553
9554 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9555
9556 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9557 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9558 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9559 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9560 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9561
9562 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9563 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9564 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9565
9566 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9567 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9568 size_hints.base_height = base_height + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
9569 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9570 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9571 }
9572
9573 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9574 if (flags)
9575 {
9576 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9577 goto no_read;
9578 }
9579
9580 {
9581 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9582 long supplied_return;
9583 int value;
9584
9585 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9586 &supplied_return);
9587
9588 if (flags)
9589 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9590 else
9591 {
9592 if (value == 0)
9593 hints.flags = 0;
9594 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9595 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9596 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9597 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9598 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9599 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9600 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9601 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9602 }
9603 }
9604
9605 no_read:
9606
9607 #ifdef PWinGravity
9608 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9609 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9610
9611 if (user_position)
9612 {
9613 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9614 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9615 }
9616 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9617
9618 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9619 }
9620 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9621
9622 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9623
9624 static void
9625 x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *f, int state)
9626 {
9627 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9628 Arg al[1];
9629
9630 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9631 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9632 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9633 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9634
9635 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9636 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9637
9638 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9639 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9640 }
9641
9642 static void
9643 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *f, ptrdiff_t pixmap_id)
9644 {
9645 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9646
9647 #if !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
9648 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9649 #endif
9650
9651 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9652 {
9653 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9654 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9655 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9656 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9657 }
9658 else
9659 {
9660 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon
9661 pixmap. */
9662 return;
9663 }
9664
9665
9666 #ifdef USE_GTK
9667 {
9668 xg_set_frame_icon (f, icon_pixmap, icon_mask);
9669 return;
9670 }
9671
9672 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9673
9674 {
9675 Arg al[1];
9676 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9677 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9678 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9679 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9680 }
9681
9682 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9683
9684 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9685 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9686
9687 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9688 }
9689
9690 void
9691 x_wm_set_icon_position (struct frame *f, int icon_x, int icon_y)
9692 {
9693 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9694
9695 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9696 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9697 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9698
9699 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9700 }
9701
9702 \f
9703 /***********************************************************************
9704 Fonts
9705 ***********************************************************************/
9706
9707 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
9708
9709 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9710 font table. */
9711
9712 static void
9713 x_check_font (struct frame *f, struct font *font)
9714 {
9715 xassert (font != NULL && ! NILP (font->props[FONT_TYPE_INDEX]));
9716 if (font->driver->check)
9717 xassert (font->driver->check (f, font) == 0);
9718 }
9719
9720 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
9721
9722 \f
9723 /***********************************************************************
9724 Initialization
9725 ***********************************************************************/
9726
9727 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9728 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
9729 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9730 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
9731
9732 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
9733 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9734 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9735
9736 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9737 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9738 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9739 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9740 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9741 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9742 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
9743 };
9744
9745 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
9746
9747 static int x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag;
9748
9749 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9750
9751 static int x_initialized;
9752
9753 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
9754 the screen number from the server number. */
9755 static int
9756 same_x_server (const char *name1, const char *name2)
9757 {
9758 int seen_colon = 0;
9759 const char *system_name = SSDATA (Vsystem_name);
9760 ptrdiff_t system_name_length = SBYTES (Vsystem_name);
9761 ptrdiff_t length_until_period = 0;
9762
9763 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
9764 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
9765 length_until_period++;
9766
9767 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
9768 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
9769 name1 += 4;
9770 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
9771 name2 += 4;
9772 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
9773 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
9774 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
9775 name1 += system_name_length;
9776 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
9777 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
9778 name2 += system_name_length;
9779 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
9780 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
9781 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
9782 name1 += length_until_period;
9783 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
9784 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
9785 name2 += length_until_period;
9786
9787 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
9788 {
9789 if (*name1 == ':')
9790 seen_colon = 1;
9791 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
9792 return 1;
9793 }
9794 return (seen_colon
9795 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
9796 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
9797 }
9798
9799 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
9800 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
9801 to 5. */
9802 static void
9803 get_bits_and_offset (long unsigned int mask, int *bits, int *offset)
9804 {
9805 int nr = 0;
9806 int off = 0;
9807
9808 while (!(mask & 1))
9809 {
9810 off++;
9811 mask >>= 1;
9812 }
9813
9814 while (mask & 1)
9815 {
9816 nr++;
9817 mask >>= 1;
9818 }
9819
9820 *offset = off;
9821 *bits = nr;
9822 }
9823
9824 /* Return 1 if display DISPLAY is available for use, 0 otherwise.
9825 But don't permanently open it, just test its availability. */
9826
9827 int
9828 x_display_ok (const char *display)
9829 {
9830 int dpy_ok = 1;
9831 Display *dpy;
9832
9833 dpy = XOpenDisplay (display);
9834 if (dpy)
9835 XCloseDisplay (dpy);
9836 else
9837 dpy_ok = 0;
9838 return dpy_ok;
9839 }
9840
9841 #ifdef USE_GTK
9842 static void
9843 my_log_handler (const gchar *log_domain, GLogLevelFlags log_level,
9844 const gchar *msg, gpointer user_data)
9845 {
9846 if (!strstr (msg, "g_set_prgname"))
9847 fprintf (stderr, "%s-WARNING **: %s\n", log_domain, msg);
9848 }
9849 #endif
9850
9851 /* Open a connection to X display DISPLAY_NAME, and return
9852 the structure that describes the open display.
9853 If we cannot contact the display, return null. */
9854
9855 struct x_display_info *
9856 x_term_init (Lisp_Object display_name, char *xrm_option, char *resource_name)
9857 {
9858 int connection;
9859 Display *dpy;
9860 struct terminal *terminal;
9861 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
9862 XrmDatabase xrdb;
9863 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo;
9864 ptrdiff_t lim;
9865
9866 BLOCK_INPUT;
9867
9868 if (!x_initialized)
9869 {
9870 x_initialize ();
9871 ++x_initialized;
9872 }
9873
9874 if (! x_display_ok (SSDATA (display_name)))
9875 error ("Display %s can't be opened", SSDATA (display_name));
9876
9877 #ifdef USE_GTK
9878 {
9879 #define NUM_ARGV 10
9880 int argc;
9881 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
9882 char **argv2 = argv;
9883 guint id;
9884
9885 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
9886 {
9887 xg_display_open (SSDATA (display_name), &dpy);
9888 }
9889 else
9890 {
9891 static char display_opt[] = "--display";
9892 static char name_opt[] = "--name";
9893
9894 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
9895 argv[argc] = 0;
9896
9897 argc = 0;
9898 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
9899
9900 if (! NILP (display_name))
9901 {
9902 argv[argc++] = display_opt;
9903 argv[argc++] = SSDATA (display_name);
9904 }
9905
9906 argv[argc++] = name_opt;
9907 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
9908
9909 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9910
9911 /* Emacs can only handle core input events, so make sure
9912 Gtk doesn't use Xinput or Xinput2 extensions. */
9913 {
9914 static char fix_events[] = "GDK_CORE_DEVICE_EVENTS=1";
9915 putenv (fix_events);
9916 }
9917
9918 /* Work around GLib bug that outputs a faulty warning. See
9919 https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=563627. */
9920 id = g_log_set_handler ("GLib", G_LOG_LEVEL_WARNING | G_LOG_FLAG_FATAL
9921 | G_LOG_FLAG_RECURSION, my_log_handler, NULL);
9922 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
9923 g_log_remove_handler ("GLib", id);
9924
9925 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
9926 fixup_locale ();
9927 xg_initialize ();
9928
9929 dpy = DEFAULT_GDK_DISPLAY ();
9930
9931 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function */
9932 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
9933
9934 #if GTK_MAJOR_VERSION <= 2 && GTK_MINOR_VERSION <= 90
9935 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
9936 {
9937 const char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
9938 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
9939
9940 s = make_string (file, strlen (file));
9941 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
9942
9943 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
9944 gtk_rc_parse (SSDATA (abs_file));
9945 }
9946 #endif
9947
9948 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
9949 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
9950 }
9951 }
9952 #else /* not USE_GTK */
9953 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9954 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
9955 errors with X11R5:
9956 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
9957 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
9958 So let's not use it until R6. */
9959 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
9960 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
9961 #endif
9962
9963 {
9964 int argc = 0;
9965 char *argv[3];
9966
9967 argv[0] = "";
9968 argc = 1;
9969 if (xrm_option)
9970 {
9971 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
9972 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
9973 }
9974 turn_on_atimers (0);
9975 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SSDATA (display_name),
9976 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
9977 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
9978 &argc, argv);
9979 turn_on_atimers (1);
9980
9981 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
9982 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
9983 fixup_locale ();
9984 #endif
9985 }
9986
9987 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9988 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9989 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SSDATA (display_name));
9990 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9991 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
9992
9993 /* Detect failure. */
9994 if (dpy == 0)
9995 {
9996 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9997 return 0;
9998 }
9999
10000 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
10001
10002 dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct x_display_info));
10003 memset (dpyinfo, 0, sizeof *dpyinfo);
10004 hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
10005
10006 terminal = x_create_terminal (dpyinfo);
10007
10008 {
10009 struct x_display_info *share;
10010 Lisp_Object tail;
10011
10012 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
10013 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
10014 if (same_x_server (SSDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
10015 SSDATA (display_name)))
10016 break;
10017 if (share)
10018 terminal->kboard = share->terminal->kboard;
10019 else
10020 {
10021 terminal->kboard = (KBOARD *) xmalloc (sizeof (KBOARD));
10022 init_kboard (terminal->kboard);
10023 KVAR (terminal->kboard, Vwindow_system) = Qx;
10024
10025 /* Add the keyboard to the list before running Lisp code (via
10026 Qvendor_specific_keysyms below), since these are not traced
10027 via terminals but only through all_kboards. */
10028 terminal->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
10029 all_kboards = terminal->kboard;
10030
10031 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
10032 {
10033 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10034
10035 /* Protect terminal from GC before removing it from the
10036 list of terminals. */
10037 struct gcpro gcpro1;
10038 Lisp_Object gcpro_term;
10039 XSETTERMINAL (gcpro_term, terminal);
10040 GCPRO1 (gcpro_term);
10041
10042 /* Temporarily hide the partially initialized terminal. */
10043 terminal_list = terminal->next_terminal;
10044 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10045 KVAR (terminal->kboard, Vsystem_key_alist)
10046 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10047 vendor ? build_string (vendor) : empty_unibyte_string);
10048 BLOCK_INPUT;
10049 terminal->next_terminal = terminal_list;
10050 terminal_list = terminal;
10051 UNGCPRO;
10052 }
10053
10054 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10055 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10056 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10057 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10058 current_kboard = terminal->kboard;
10059 }
10060 terminal->kboard->reference_count++;
10061 }
10062
10063 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10064 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10065 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10066
10067 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10068 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10069 x_display_name_list);
10070 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10071
10072 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10073
10074 /* Set the name of the terminal. */
10075 terminal->name = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (display_name) + 1);
10076 strncpy (terminal->name, SSDATA (display_name), SBYTES (display_name));
10077 terminal->name[SBYTES (display_name)] = 0;
10078
10079 #if 0
10080 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10081 #endif /* ! 0 */
10082
10083 lim = min (PTRDIFF_MAX, SIZE_MAX) - sizeof "@";
10084 if (lim - SBYTES (Vinvocation_name) < SBYTES (Vsystem_name))
10085 memory_full (SIZE_MAX);
10086 dpyinfo->x_id_name
10087 = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10088 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name)
10089 + 2);
10090 strcat (strcat (strcpy (dpyinfo->x_id_name, SSDATA (Vinvocation_name)), "@"),
10091 SSDATA (Vsystem_name));
10092
10093 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10094 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10095
10096 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10097 #ifdef USE_GTK
10098 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10099 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10100 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10101
10102 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10103 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10104
10105 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10106 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10107 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10108 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10109 #else
10110 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10111 #endif
10112 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10113 all versions. */
10114 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10115
10116 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10117 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10118 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10119 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10120 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10121 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
10122 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10123 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10124 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10125 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10126 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10127 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10128 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10129 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10130 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10131 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
10132 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10133 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10134 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10135 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10136 hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10137 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10138 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10139 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10140 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10141 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10142 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10143 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10144
10145 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10146 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
10147 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
10148
10149 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10150 {
10151 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10152 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10153 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10154 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10155 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10156 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10157 }
10158
10159 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10160 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10161 {
10162 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10163 {
10164 Lisp_Object value;
10165 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10166 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10167 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10168 Qnil, Qnil);
10169 if (STRINGP (value)
10170 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10171 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10172 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10173 }
10174 }
10175 else
10176 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10177 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10178
10179 #ifdef HAVE_XFT
10180 {
10181 /* If we are using Xft, check dpi value in X resources.
10182 It is better we use it as well, since Xft will use it, as will all
10183 Gnome applications. If our real DPI is smaller or larger than the
10184 one Xft uses, our font will look smaller or larger than other
10185 for other applications, even if it is the same font name (monospace-10
10186 for example). */
10187 char *v = XGetDefault (dpyinfo->display, "Xft", "dpi");
10188 double d;
10189 if (v != NULL && sscanf (v, "%lf", &d) == 1)
10190 dpyinfo->resy = dpyinfo->resx = d;
10191 }
10192 #endif
10193
10194 if (dpyinfo->resy < 1)
10195 {
10196 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10197 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10198 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10199 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10200 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10201 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10202 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10203 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10204 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10205 }
10206
10207 {
10208 const struct
10209 {
10210 const char *name;
10211 Atom *atom;
10212 } atom_refs[] = {
10213 { "WM_PROTOCOLS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols },
10214 { "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus },
10215 { "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself },
10216 { "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window },
10217 { "WM_CHANGE_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state },
10218 { "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied },
10219 { "WM_MOVED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved },
10220 { "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader },
10221 { "Editres", &dpyinfo->Xatom_editres },
10222 { "CLIPBOARD", &dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD },
10223 { "TIMESTAMP", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP },
10224 { "TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT },
10225 { "COMPOUND_TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT },
10226 { "UTF8_STRING", &dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING },
10227 { "DELETE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE },
10228 { "MULTIPLE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE },
10229 { "INCR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR },
10230 { "_EMACS_TMP_", &dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP },
10231 { "TARGETS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS },
10232 { "NULL", &dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL },
10233 { "ATOM", &dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM },
10234 { "ATOM_PAIR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR },
10235 { "CLIPBOARD_MANAGER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD_MANAGER },
10236 { "_XEMBED_INFO", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO },
10237 /* For properties of font. */
10238 { "PIXEL_SIZE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE },
10239 { "AVERAGE_WIDTH", &dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH },
10240 { "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET },
10241 { "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE },
10242 { "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT },
10243 /* Ghostscript support. */
10244 { "DONE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE },
10245 { "PAGE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE },
10246 { "SCROLLBAR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar },
10247 { "_XEMBED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED },
10248 /* EWMH */
10249 { "_NET_WM_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state },
10250 { "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen },
10251 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ",
10252 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz },
10253 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT",
10254 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert },
10255 { "_NET_WM_STATE_STICKY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky },
10256 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type },
10257 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE_TOOLTIP",
10258 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type_tooltip },
10259 { "_NET_WM_ICON_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_icon_name },
10260 { "_NET_WM_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_name },
10261 { "_NET_SUPPORTED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported },
10262 { "_NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check },
10263 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_OPACITY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity },
10264 { "_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window },
10265 { "_NET_FRAME_EXTENTS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_frame_extents },
10266 /* Session management */
10267 { "SM_CLIENT_ID", &dpyinfo->Xatom_SM_CLIENT_ID },
10268 { "_XSETTINGS_SETTINGS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_prop },
10269 { "MANAGER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_mgr },
10270 };
10271
10272 int i;
10273 const int atom_count = sizeof (atom_refs) / sizeof (atom_refs[0]);
10274 /* 1 for _XSETTINGS_SN */
10275 const int total_atom_count = 1 + atom_count;
10276 Atom *atoms_return = xmalloc (sizeof (Atom) * total_atom_count);
10277 char **atom_names = xmalloc (sizeof (char *) * total_atom_count);
10278 char xsettings_atom_name[64];
10279
10280 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10281 atom_names[i] = (char *) atom_refs[i].name;
10282
10283 /* Build _XSETTINGS_SN atom name */
10284 snprintf (xsettings_atom_name, sizeof (xsettings_atom_name),
10285 "_XSETTINGS_S%d", XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen));
10286 atom_names[i] = xsettings_atom_name;
10287
10288 XInternAtoms (dpyinfo->display, atom_names, total_atom_count,
10289 False, atoms_return);
10290
10291 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10292 *atom_refs[i].atom = atoms_return[i];
10293
10294 /* Manual copy of last atom */
10295 dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_sel = atoms_return[i];
10296
10297 xfree (atom_names);
10298 xfree (atoms_return);
10299 }
10300
10301 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size = 8;
10302 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_length = 0;
10303 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms = xmalloc (sizeof (*dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms)
10304 * dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size);
10305
10306 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
10307 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
10308 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
10309
10310 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10311 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10312
10313 {
10314 dpyinfo->gray
10315 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10316 gray_bitmap_bits,
10317 gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height,
10318 1, 0, 1);
10319 }
10320
10321 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10322 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10323 #endif
10324
10325 xsettings_initialize (dpyinfo);
10326
10327 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10328 if (connection != 0)
10329 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10330
10331 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10332 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10333 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10334
10335 #ifdef SIGIO
10336 if (interrupt_input)
10337 init_sigio (connection);
10338 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
10339
10340 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10341 {
10342 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10343 Font font;
10344
10345 dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10346 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10347 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10348 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10349 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10350 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10351 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10352 x_catch_errors (dpy);
10353 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10354 abort ();
10355 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10356 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10357 x_uncatch_errors ();
10358 }
10359 #endif
10360
10361 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10362 for debugging X code. */
10363 {
10364 Lisp_Object value;
10365 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10366 build_string ("synchronous"),
10367 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10368 Qnil, Qnil);
10369 if (STRINGP (value)
10370 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10371 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10372 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10373 }
10374
10375 {
10376 Lisp_Object value;
10377 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10378 build_string ("useXIM"),
10379 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10380 Qnil, Qnil);
10381 #ifdef USE_XIM
10382 if (STRINGP (value)
10383 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "false")
10384 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "off")))
10385 use_xim = 0;
10386 #else
10387 if (STRINGP (value)
10388 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10389 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10390 use_xim = 1;
10391 #endif
10392 }
10393
10394 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10395 /* Only do this for the very first display in the Emacs session.
10396 Ignore X session management when Emacs was first started on a
10397 tty. */
10398 if (terminal->id == 1)
10399 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10400 #endif
10401
10402 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10403
10404 return dpyinfo;
10405 }
10406 \f
10407 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, deleting all frames on it,
10408 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10409
10410 static void
10411 x_delete_display (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10412 {
10413 struct terminal *t;
10414
10415 /* Close all frames and delete the generic struct terminal for this
10416 X display. */
10417 for (t = terminal_list; t; t = t->next_terminal)
10418 if (t->type == output_x_window && t->display_info.x == dpyinfo)
10419 {
10420 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10421 /* Close X session management when we close its display. */
10422 if (t->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
10423 x_session_close ();
10424 #endif
10425 delete_terminal (t);
10426 break;
10427 }
10428
10429 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10430
10431 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10432 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10433 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10434 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10435 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10436 else
10437 {
10438 Lisp_Object tail;
10439
10440 tail = x_display_name_list;
10441 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10442 {
10443 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10444 {
10445 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10446 break;
10447 }
10448 tail = XCDR (tail);
10449 }
10450 }
10451
10452 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10453 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10454
10455 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10456 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10457 else
10458 {
10459 struct x_display_info *tail;
10460
10461 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10462 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10463 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10464 }
10465
10466 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10467 xfree (dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms);
10468 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10469 xfree (dpyinfo);
10470 }
10471
10472 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10473
10474 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10475 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10476 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10477 that slows us down. */
10478
10479 static void
10480 x_process_timeouts (struct atimer *timer)
10481 {
10482 BLOCK_INPUT;
10483 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 0;
10484 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10485 {
10486 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10487 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10488 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
10489 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
10490 }
10491 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10492 }
10493
10494 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10495 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
10496 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
10497 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
10498 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
10499 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
10500 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
10501
10502 void
10503 x_activate_timeout_atimer (void)
10504 {
10505 BLOCK_INPUT;
10506 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag)
10507 {
10508 EMACS_TIME interval;
10509
10510 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval, 0, 100000);
10511 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10512 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 1;
10513 }
10514 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10515 }
10516
10517 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10518
10519 \f
10520 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10521
10522 extern frame_parm_handler x_frame_parm_handlers[];
10523
10524 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10525 {
10526 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10527 x_produce_glyphs,
10528 x_write_glyphs,
10529 x_insert_glyphs,
10530 x_clear_end_of_line,
10531 x_scroll_run,
10532 x_after_update_window_line,
10533 x_update_window_begin,
10534 x_update_window_end,
10535 x_cursor_to,
10536 x_flush,
10537 #ifdef XFlush
10538 x_flush,
10539 #else
10540 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10541 #endif
10542 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10543 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10544 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10545 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10546 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10547 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10548 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10549 x_draw_glyph_string,
10550 x_define_frame_cursor,
10551 x_clear_frame_area,
10552 x_draw_window_cursor,
10553 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10554 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10555 };
10556
10557
10558 /* This function is called when the last frame on a display is deleted. */
10559 void
10560 x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *terminal)
10561 {
10562 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = terminal->display_info.x;
10563
10564 /* Protect against recursive calls. delete_frame in
10565 delete_terminal calls us back when it deletes our last frame. */
10566 if (!terminal->name)
10567 return;
10568
10569 BLOCK_INPUT;
10570 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10571 /* We must close our connection to the XIM server before closing the
10572 X display. */
10573 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10574 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10575 #endif
10576
10577 /* If called from x_connection_closed, the display may already be closed
10578 and dpyinfo->display was set to 0 to indicate that. */
10579 if (dpyinfo->display)
10580 {
10581 x_destroy_all_bitmaps (dpyinfo);
10582 XSetCloseDownMode (dpyinfo->display, DestroyAll);
10583
10584 /* Whether or not XCloseDisplay destroys the associated resource
10585 database depends on the version of libX11. To avoid both
10586 crash and memory leak, we dissociate the database from the
10587 display and then destroy dpyinfo->xrdb ourselves.
10588
10589 Unfortunately, the above strategy does not work in some
10590 situations due to a bug in newer versions of libX11: because
10591 XrmSetDatabase doesn't clear the flag XlibDisplayDfltRMDB if
10592 dpy->db is NULL, XCloseDisplay destroys the associated
10593 database whereas it has not been created by XGetDefault
10594 (Bug#21974 in freedesktop.org Bugzilla). As a workaround, we
10595 don't destroy the database here in order to avoid the crash
10596 in the above situations for now, though that may cause memory
10597 leaks in other situations. */
10598 #if 0
10599 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10600 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, NULL);
10601 #else
10602 dpyinfo->display->db = NULL;
10603 #endif
10604 /* We used to call XrmDestroyDatabase from x_delete_display, but
10605 some older versions of libX11 crash if we call it after
10606 closing all the displays. */
10607 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10608 #endif
10609
10610 #ifdef USE_GTK
10611 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
10612 #else
10613 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10614 XtCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10615 #else
10616 XCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10617 #endif
10618 #endif /* ! USE_GTK */
10619 }
10620
10621 /* Mark as dead. */
10622 dpyinfo->display = NULL;
10623 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
10624 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10625 }
10626
10627 /* Create a struct terminal, initialize it with the X11 specific
10628 functions and make DISPLAY->TERMINAL point to it. */
10629
10630 static struct terminal *
10631 x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10632 {
10633 struct terminal *terminal;
10634
10635 terminal = create_terminal ();
10636
10637 terminal->type = output_x_window;
10638 terminal->display_info.x = dpyinfo;
10639 dpyinfo->terminal = terminal;
10640
10641 /* kboard is initialized in x_term_init. */
10642
10643 terminal->clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10644 terminal->ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10645 terminal->delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10646 terminal->ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10647 terminal->toggle_invisible_pointer_hook = XTtoggle_invisible_pointer;
10648 terminal->reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10649 terminal->set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10650 terminal->update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10651 terminal->update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10652 terminal->set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10653 terminal->read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10654 terminal->frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10655 terminal->mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10656 terminal->frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10657 terminal->frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10658 terminal->fullscreen_hook = XTfullscreen_hook;
10659 terminal->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10660 terminal->condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10661 terminal->redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10662 terminal->judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10663
10664 terminal->delete_frame_hook = x_destroy_window;
10665 terminal->delete_terminal_hook = x_delete_terminal;
10666
10667 terminal->rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10668 terminal->scroll_region_ok = 1; /* We'll scroll partial frames. */
10669 terminal->char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10670 terminal->line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* We'll just blt 'em. */
10671 terminal->fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well. */
10672 terminal->memory_below_frame = 0; /* We don't remember what scrolls
10673 off the bottom. */
10674
10675 return terminal;
10676 }
10677
10678 void
10679 x_initialize (void)
10680 {
10681 baud_rate = 19200;
10682
10683 x_noop_count = 0;
10684 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10685 any_help_event_p = 0;
10686 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
10687
10688 #ifdef USE_GTK
10689 current_count = -1;
10690 #endif
10691
10692 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10693 Fset_input_interrupt_mode (Qt);
10694
10695 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10696 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10697
10698 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10699
10700 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10701 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10702 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10703 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10704 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10705 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10706 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10707
10708 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10709 #endif
10710
10711 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10712 #ifndef USE_GTK
10713 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10714 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10715 #endif
10716 #endif
10717
10718 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
10719 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
10720 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
10721
10722 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10723 original error handler. */
10724 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10725 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10726
10727 signal (SIGPIPE, x_connection_signal);
10728
10729 xgselect_initialize ();
10730 }
10731
10732
10733 void
10734 syms_of_xterm (void)
10735 {
10736 x_error_message = NULL;
10737
10738 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10739 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10740
10741 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10742 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10743
10744 DEFSYM (Qvendor_specific_keysyms, "vendor-specific-keysyms");
10745 DEFSYM (Qlatin_1, "latin-1");
10746
10747 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
10748 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10749
10750 #ifdef USE_GTK
10751 xg_default_icon_file = make_pure_c_string ("icons/hicolor/scalable/apps/emacs.svg");
10752 staticpro (&xg_default_icon_file);
10753
10754 DEFSYM (Qx_gtk_map_stock, "x-gtk-map-stock");
10755 #endif
10756
10757 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10758 x_use_underline_position_properties,
10759 doc: /* *Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10760 A value of nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10761 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10762 to 4.1, set this to nil. You can also use `underline-minimum-offset'
10763 to override the font's UNDERLINE_POSITION for small font display
10764 sizes. */);
10765 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10766
10767 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
10768 x_underline_at_descent_line,
10769 doc: /* *Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
10770 A value of nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the
10771 variable `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the
10772 baseline level. The default value is nil. */);
10773 x_underline_at_descent_line = 0;
10774
10775 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
10776 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
10777 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
10778 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
10779 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
10780 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
10781 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
10782 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
10783 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
10784
10785 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10786 doc: /* Which toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses, if any.
10787 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use toolkit scroll bars.
10788 With the X Window system, the value is a symbol describing the
10789 X toolkit. Possible values are: gtk, motif, xaw, or xaw3d.
10790 With MS Windows, the value is t. */);
10791 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10792 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10793 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("motif");
10794 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10795 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw3d");
10796 #elif USE_GTK
10797 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("gtk");
10798 #else
10799 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw");
10800 #endif
10801 #else
10802 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10803 #endif
10804
10805 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10806 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10807
10808 Qmodifier_value = intern_c_string ("modifier-value");
10809 Qalt = intern_c_string ("alt");
10810 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10811 Qhyper = intern_c_string ("hyper");
10812 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10813 Qmeta = intern_c_string ("meta");
10814 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10815 Qsuper = intern_c_string ("super");
10816 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10817
10818 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", Vx_alt_keysym,
10819 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10820 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10821 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10822 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10823 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10824
10825 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", Vx_hyper_keysym,
10826 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10827 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10828 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10829 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10830 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10831
10832 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", Vx_meta_keysym,
10833 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10834 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10835 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10836 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10837 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10838
10839 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", Vx_super_keysym,
10840 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10841 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10842 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10843 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10844 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10845
10846 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", Vx_keysym_table,
10847 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10848 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (Qeql, make_number (900),
10849 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10850 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10851 Qnil, Qnil, Qnil);
10852 }
10853
10854 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */